1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 21 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 22 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h" 23 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 24 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 28 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 29 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 30 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 31 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 32 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 33 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" 34 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 37 #include <algorithm> 38 #include <cstdlib> 39 40 using namespace clang; 41 using namespace sema; 42 43 using AllowedExplicit = Sema::AllowedExplicit; 44 45 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 46 return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 47 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 48 }); 49 } 50 51 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function. 52 static ExprResult 53 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 54 const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 55 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(), 56 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){ 57 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc)) 58 return ExprError(); 59 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template 60 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 61 // called on both. 62 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 63 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 64 // being used. 65 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc)) 66 return ExprError(); 67 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) 68 DeclRefExpr(S.Context, Fn, false, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo); 69 if (HadMultipleCandidates) 70 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 71 72 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base); 73 if (auto *FPT = DRE->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 74 if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) { 75 S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 76 DRE->setType(Fn->getType()); 77 } 78 } 79 return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()), 80 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay); 81 } 82 83 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 84 bool InOverloadResolution, 85 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 86 bool CStyle, 87 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 88 89 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 90 QualType &ToType, 91 bool InOverloadResolution, 92 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 93 bool CStyle); 94 static OverloadingResult 95 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 96 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 97 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 98 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 99 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 100 101 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 102 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 103 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 104 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 105 106 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 107 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 108 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 109 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 110 111 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 112 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 113 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 114 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 115 116 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 117 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 118 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 119 static const ImplicitConversionRank 120 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 121 ICR_Exact_Match, 122 ICR_Exact_Match, 123 ICR_Exact_Match, 124 ICR_Exact_Match, 125 ICR_Exact_Match, 126 ICR_Exact_Match, 127 ICR_Promotion, 128 ICR_Promotion, 129 ICR_Promotion, 130 ICR_Conversion, 131 ICR_Conversion, 132 ICR_Conversion, 133 ICR_Conversion, 134 ICR_Conversion, 135 ICR_Conversion, 136 ICR_Conversion, 137 ICR_Conversion, 138 ICR_Conversion, 139 ICR_Conversion, 140 ICR_Conversion, 141 ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening, 142 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion, 143 ICR_Conversion, 144 ICR_Conversion, 145 ICR_Writeback_Conversion, 146 ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right -- 147 // it was omitted by the patch that added 148 // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion 149 ICR_C_Conversion, 150 ICR_C_Conversion_Extension 151 }; 152 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 153 } 154 155 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 156 /// implicit conversion. 157 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 158 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 159 "No conversion", 160 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 161 "Array-to-pointer", 162 "Function-to-pointer", 163 "Function pointer conversion", 164 "Qualification", 165 "Integral promotion", 166 "Floating point promotion", 167 "Complex promotion", 168 "Integral conversion", 169 "Floating conversion", 170 "Complex conversion", 171 "Floating-integral conversion", 172 "Pointer conversion", 173 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 174 "Boolean conversion", 175 "Compatible-types conversion", 176 "Derived-to-base conversion", 177 "Vector conversion", 178 "SVE Vector conversion", 179 "Vector splat", 180 "Complex-real conversion", 181 "Block Pointer conversion", 182 "Transparent Union Conversion", 183 "Writeback conversion", 184 "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion", 185 "C specific type conversion", 186 "Incompatible pointer conversion" 187 }; 188 return Name[Kind]; 189 } 190 191 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 192 /// sequence to the identity conversion. 193 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 194 First = ICK_Identity; 195 Second = ICK_Identity; 196 Third = ICK_Identity; 197 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 198 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 199 ReferenceBinding = false; 200 DirectBinding = false; 201 IsLvalueReference = true; 202 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 203 BindsToRvalue = false; 204 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 205 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 206 CopyConstructor = nullptr; 207 } 208 209 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 210 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 211 /// implicit conversions. 212 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 213 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 214 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 215 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 216 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 217 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 218 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 219 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 220 return Rank; 221 } 222 223 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 224 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 225 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 226 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 227 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 228 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 229 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 230 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 231 // a pointer. 232 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 233 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 234 getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() || 235 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 236 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 237 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 238 return true; 239 240 return false; 241 } 242 243 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 244 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 245 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 246 /// 13.3.3.2p4). 247 bool 248 StandardConversionSequence:: 249 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 250 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 251 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 252 253 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 254 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 255 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 256 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 257 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 258 259 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType()) 260 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 261 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 262 263 return false; 264 } 265 266 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion 267 /// or after one in an implicit conversion. 268 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(ASTContext &Ctx, 269 const Expr *Converted) { 270 // We can have cleanups wrapping the converted expression; these need to be 271 // preserved so that destructors run if necessary. 272 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Converted)) { 273 Expr *Inner = 274 const_cast<Expr *>(IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, EWC->getSubExpr())); 275 return ExprWithCleanups::Create(Ctx, Inner, EWC->cleanupsHaveSideEffects(), 276 EWC->getObjects()); 277 } 278 279 while (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) { 280 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 281 case CK_NoOp: 282 case CK_IntegralCast: 283 case CK_IntegralToBoolean: 284 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 285 case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral: 286 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 287 case CK_FloatingToBoolean: 288 case CK_FloatingCast: 289 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr(); 290 continue; 291 292 default: 293 return Converted; 294 } 295 } 296 297 return Converted; 298 } 299 300 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing 301 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7. 302 /// 303 /// \param Ctx The AST context. 304 /// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence. 305 /// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 306 /// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 307 /// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 308 /// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 309 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions 310 /// from floating point types to integral types should be ignored. 311 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind( 312 ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue, 313 QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const { 314 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++"); 315 316 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7: 317 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ... 318 QualType FromType = getToType(0); 319 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 320 321 // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to 322 // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of 323 // the form 'Enum{init}'. 324 if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>()) 325 ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 326 327 switch (Second) { 328 // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it. 329 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 330 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType()) 331 goto FloatingIntegralConversion; 332 if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 333 goto IntegralConversion; 334 // -- from a pointer type or pointer-to-member type to bool, or 335 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 336 337 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or 338 // 339 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point 340 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual 341 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce 342 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or 343 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 344 FloatingIntegralConversion: 345 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) { 346 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 347 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 348 ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 349 if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) 350 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 351 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 352 assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression"); 353 354 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 355 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 356 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 357 358 if (Optional<llvm::APSInt> IntConstantValue = 359 Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx)) { 360 // Convert the integer to the floating type. 361 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)); 362 Result.convertFromAPInt(*IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue->isSigned(), 363 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven); 364 // And back. 365 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = *IntConstantValue; 366 bool ignored; 367 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue, 368 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored); 369 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 370 if (*IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) { 371 ConstantValue = APValue(*IntConstantValue); 372 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 373 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 374 } 375 } else { 376 // Variables are always narrowings. 377 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 378 } 379 } 380 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 381 382 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except 383 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 384 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even 385 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or 386 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 387 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() && 388 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) { 389 // FromType is larger than ToType. 390 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 391 392 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 393 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 394 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 395 396 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) { 397 // Constant! 398 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat()); 399 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat(); 400 // Convert the source value into the target type. 401 bool ignored; 402 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert( 403 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType), 404 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); 405 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of 406 // values that can be represented. 407 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) { 408 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 409 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 410 } 411 } else { 412 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 413 } 414 } 415 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 416 417 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type 418 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where 419 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 420 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original 421 // value when converted back to the original type. 422 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: 423 IntegralConversion: { 424 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 425 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 426 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 427 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType); 428 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 429 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType); 430 431 if (FromWidth > ToWidth || 432 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) || 433 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) { 434 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType. 435 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 436 437 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 438 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 439 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 440 441 Optional<llvm::APSInt> OptInitializerValue; 442 if (!(OptInitializerValue = Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx))) { 443 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing. 444 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 445 } 446 llvm::APSInt &InitializerValue = *OptInitializerValue; 447 bool Narrowing = false; 448 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) { 449 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never 450 // narrowing. 451 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative()) 452 Narrowing = true; 453 } else { 454 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about 455 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons. 456 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend( 457 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1); 458 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness. 459 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue; 460 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth); 461 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned); 462 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth()); 463 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned()); 464 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 465 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue) 466 Narrowing = true; 467 } 468 if (Narrowing) { 469 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 470 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue); 471 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 472 } 473 } 474 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 475 } 476 477 default: 478 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings. 479 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 480 } 481 } 482 483 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 484 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 485 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const { 486 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 487 bool PrintedSomething = false; 488 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 489 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 490 PrintedSomething = true; 491 } 492 493 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 494 if (PrintedSomething) { 495 OS << " -> "; 496 } 497 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 498 499 if (CopyConstructor) { 500 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 501 } else if (DirectBinding) { 502 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 503 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 504 OS << " (reference binding)"; 505 } 506 PrintedSomething = true; 507 } 508 509 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 510 if (PrintedSomething) { 511 OS << " -> "; 512 } 513 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 514 PrintedSomething = true; 515 } 516 517 if (!PrintedSomething) { 518 OS << "No conversions required"; 519 } 520 } 521 522 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 523 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 524 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const { 525 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 526 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 527 Before.dump(); 528 OS << " -> "; 529 } 530 if (ConversionFunction) 531 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\''; 532 else 533 OS << "aggregate initialization"; 534 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 535 OS << " -> "; 536 After.dump(); 537 } 538 } 539 540 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 541 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 542 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const { 543 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 544 if (isStdInitializerListElement()) 545 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: "; 546 switch (ConversionKind) { 547 case StandardConversion: 548 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 549 Standard.dump(); 550 break; 551 case UserDefinedConversion: 552 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 553 UserDefined.dump(); 554 break; 555 case EllipsisConversion: 556 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 557 break; 558 case AmbiguousConversion: 559 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 560 break; 561 case BadConversion: 562 OS << "Bad conversion"; 563 break; 564 } 565 566 OS << "\n"; 567 } 568 569 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 570 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 571 } 572 573 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 574 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 575 } 576 577 void 578 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 579 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 580 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 581 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 582 } 583 584 namespace { 585 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 586 // template argument information. 587 struct DFIArguments { 588 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 589 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 590 }; 591 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 592 // template parameter and template argument information. 593 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments { 594 TemplateParameter Param; 595 }; 596 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument 597 // information and the index of the problematic call argument. 598 struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments { 599 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 600 unsigned CallArgIndex; 601 }; 602 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store information about 603 // unsatisfied constraints. 604 struct CNSInfo { 605 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 606 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 607 }; 608 } 609 610 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 611 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 612 DeductionFailureInfo 613 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 614 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 615 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 616 DeductionFailureInfo Result; 617 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 618 Result.HasDiagnostic = false; 619 switch (TDK) { 620 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 621 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 622 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 623 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 624 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 625 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 626 Result.Data = nullptr; 627 break; 628 629 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 630 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 631 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 632 break; 633 634 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 635 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 636 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 637 auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs; 638 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 639 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 640 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 641 Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex; 642 Result.Data = Saved; 643 break; 644 } 645 646 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 647 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 648 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments; 649 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 650 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 651 Result.Data = Saved; 652 break; 653 } 654 655 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 656 // FIXME: It's slightly wasteful to allocate two TemplateArguments for this. 657 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 658 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 659 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 660 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 661 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 662 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 663 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 664 Result.Data = Saved; 665 break; 666 } 667 668 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 669 Result.Data = Info.take(); 670 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 671 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt( 672 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic()); 673 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag); 674 Result.HasDiagnostic = true; 675 } 676 break; 677 678 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: { 679 CNSInfo *Saved = new (Context) CNSInfo; 680 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 681 Saved->Satisfaction = Info.AssociatedConstraintsSatisfaction; 682 Result.Data = Saved; 683 break; 684 } 685 686 case Sema::TDK_Success: 687 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 688 llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure"); 689 } 690 691 return Result; 692 } 693 694 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 695 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 696 case Sema::TDK_Success: 697 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 698 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 699 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 700 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 701 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 702 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 703 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 704 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 705 break; 706 707 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 708 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 709 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 710 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 711 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 712 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 713 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 714 Data = nullptr; 715 break; 716 717 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 718 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 719 Data = nullptr; 720 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 721 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 722 HasDiagnostic = false; 723 } 724 break; 725 726 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 727 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 728 Data = nullptr; 729 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 730 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 731 HasDiagnostic = false; 732 } 733 break; 734 735 // Unhandled 736 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 737 break; 738 } 739 } 740 741 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() { 742 if (HasDiagnostic) 743 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic)); 744 return nullptr; 745 } 746 747 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 748 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 749 case Sema::TDK_Success: 750 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 751 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 752 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 753 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 754 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 755 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 756 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 757 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 758 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 759 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 760 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 761 return TemplateParameter(); 762 763 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 764 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 765 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 766 767 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 768 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 769 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 770 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 771 772 // Unhandled 773 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 774 break; 775 } 776 777 return TemplateParameter(); 778 } 779 780 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 781 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 782 case Sema::TDK_Success: 783 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 784 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 785 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 786 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 787 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 788 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 789 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 790 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 791 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 792 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 793 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 794 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 795 return nullptr; 796 797 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 798 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 799 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 800 801 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 802 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 803 804 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 805 return static_cast<CNSInfo*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 806 807 // Unhandled 808 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 809 break; 810 } 811 812 return nullptr; 813 } 814 815 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 816 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 817 case Sema::TDK_Success: 818 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 819 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 820 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 821 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 822 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 823 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 824 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 825 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 826 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 827 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 828 return nullptr; 829 830 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 831 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 832 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 833 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 834 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 835 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 836 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 837 838 // Unhandled 839 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 840 break; 841 } 842 843 return nullptr; 844 } 845 846 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 847 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 848 case Sema::TDK_Success: 849 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 850 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 851 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 852 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 853 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 854 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 855 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 856 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 857 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 858 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 859 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 860 return nullptr; 861 862 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 863 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 864 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 865 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 866 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 867 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 868 869 // Unhandled 870 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 871 break; 872 } 873 874 return nullptr; 875 } 876 877 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() { 878 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 879 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 880 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 881 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex; 882 883 default: 884 return llvm::None; 885 } 886 } 887 888 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed( 889 OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 890 if (!AllowRewrittenCandidates) 891 return false; 892 return Op == OO_EqualEqual || Op == OO_Spaceship; 893 } 894 895 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed( 896 ASTContext &Ctx, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 897 if (!shouldAddReversed(FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator())) 898 return false; 899 // Don't bother adding a reversed candidate that can never be a better 900 // match than the non-reversed version. 901 return FD->getNumParams() != 2 || 902 !Ctx.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FD->getParamDecl(0)->getType(), 903 FD->getParamDecl(1)->getType()) || 904 FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 905 } 906 907 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 908 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 909 for (auto &C : i->Conversions) 910 C.~ImplicitConversionSequence(); 911 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 912 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 913 } 914 } 915 916 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) { 917 destroyCandidates(); 918 SlabAllocator.Reset(); 919 NumInlineBytesUsed = 0; 920 Candidates.clear(); 921 Functions.clear(); 922 Kind = CSK; 923 } 924 925 namespace { 926 class UnbridgedCastsSet { 927 struct Entry { 928 Expr **Addr; 929 Expr *Saved; 930 }; 931 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries; 932 933 public: 934 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) { 935 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast)); 936 Entry entry = { &E, E }; 937 Entries.push_back(entry); 938 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 939 } 940 941 void restore() { 942 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator 943 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i) 944 *i->Addr = i->Saved; 945 } 946 }; 947 } 948 949 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like 950 /// preprocessing on the given expression. 951 /// 952 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts; 953 /// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors 954 /// 955 /// Return true on unrecoverable error. 956 static bool 957 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E, 958 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) { 959 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 960 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload 961 // resolution might reasonably tweak them. 962 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false; 963 964 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip 965 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration. 966 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 967 unbridgedCasts) { 968 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E); 969 return false; 970 } 971 972 // Go ahead and check everything else. 973 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 974 if (result.isInvalid()) 975 return true; 976 977 E = result.get(); 978 return false; 979 } 980 981 // Nothing to do. 982 return false; 983 } 984 985 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for 986 /// placeholders. 987 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, 988 MultiExprArg Args, 989 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) { 990 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 991 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged)) 992 return true; 993 994 return false; 995 } 996 997 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the 998 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if 999 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as 1000 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't 1001 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or 1002 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be 1003 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying 1004 /// declaration. 1005 /// 1006 /// Example: Given the following input: 1007 /// 1008 /// void f(int, float); // #1 1009 /// void f(int, int); // #2 1010 /// int f(int, int); // #3 1011 /// 1012 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload 1013 /// will not be used. 1014 /// 1015 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing 1016 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have 1017 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is 1018 /// unchanged. 1019 /// 1020 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare 1021 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then 1022 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of 1023 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and 1024 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 1025 /// 1026 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class 1027 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations 1028 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's 1029 /// signature. 1030 Sema::OverloadKind 1031 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 1032 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 1033 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 1034 I != E; ++I) { 1035 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 1036 1037 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 1038 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 1039 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 1040 1041 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 1042 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 1043 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 1044 1045 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 1046 } 1047 1048 // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration 1049 // if one of them is hidden. 1050 if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I)) 1051 continue; 1052 1053 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 1054 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 1055 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 1056 // function templates hide function templates with different 1057 // return types or template parameter lists. 1058 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 1059 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() && 1060 !New->getFriendObjectKind(); 1061 1062 if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) { 1063 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 1064 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 1065 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 1066 continue; 1067 } 1068 1069 if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) && 1070 !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New)) 1071 continue; 1072 1073 Match = *I; 1074 return Ovl_Match; 1075 } 1076 1077 // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should 1078 // not be overloadable or redeclarable. 1079 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) { 1080 Match = *I; 1081 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1082 } 1083 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) { 1084 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 1085 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 1086 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 1087 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 1088 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 1089 } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 1090 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 1091 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 1092 // template instantiation. 1093 // 1094 // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class 1095 // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator. 1096 if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) { 1097 Match = *I; 1098 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1099 } 1100 } else { 1101 // (C++ 13p1): 1102 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 1103 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 1104 Match = *I; 1105 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1106 } 1107 } 1108 1109 // C++ [temp.friend]p1: 1110 // For a friend function declaration that is not a template declaration: 1111 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified or unqualified template-id, 1112 // [...], otherwise 1113 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching 1114 // non-template function is found in the specified class or namespace, 1115 // the friend declaration refers to that function, otherwise, 1116 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching function 1117 // template is found in the specified class or namespace, the friend 1118 // declaration refers to the deduced specialization of that function 1119 // template, otherwise 1120 // -- the name shall be an unqualified-id [...] 1121 // If we get here for a qualified friend declaration, we've just reached the 1122 // third bullet. If the type of the friend is dependent, skip this lookup 1123 // until instantiation. 1124 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && New->getQualifier() && 1125 !New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 1126 !New->getDependentSpecializationInfo() && 1127 !New->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1128 LookupResult TemplateSpecResult(LookupResult::Temporary, Old); 1129 TemplateSpecResult.addAllDecls(Old); 1130 if (CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(New, nullptr, TemplateSpecResult, 1131 /*QualifiedFriend*/true)) { 1132 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1133 return Ovl_Overload; 1134 } 1135 1136 Match = TemplateSpecResult.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>(); 1137 return Ovl_Match; 1138 } 1139 1140 return Ovl_Overload; 1141 } 1142 1143 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 1144 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs, 1145 bool ConsiderRequiresClauses) { 1146 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded. 1147 if (New->isMain()) 1148 return false; 1149 1150 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded. 1151 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 1152 return false; 1153 1154 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1155 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1156 1157 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 1158 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 1159 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 1160 if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr)) 1161 return true; 1162 1163 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 1164 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 1165 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 1166 1167 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 1168 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 1169 // in the signature, they are overloads. 1170 1171 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 1172 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 1173 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 1174 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 1175 return false; 1176 1177 const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 1178 const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 1179 1180 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 1181 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 1182 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 1183 if (OldQType != NewQType && 1184 (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() || 1185 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 1186 !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 1187 return true; 1188 1189 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 1190 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 1191 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 1192 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 1193 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 1194 // signature. 1195 // 1196 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 1197 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 1198 // 1199 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 1200 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 1201 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 1202 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1203 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1204 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 1205 !Context.hasSameType(Old->getDeclaredReturnType(), 1206 New->getDeclaredReturnType()))) 1207 return true; 1208 1209 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 1210 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself. 1211 // 1212 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 1213 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 1214 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 1215 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 1216 // can be overloaded. 1217 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 1218 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 1219 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 1220 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) { 1221 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) { 1222 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && 1223 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None || 1224 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) { 1225 // C++0x [over.load]p2: 1226 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same 1227 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template 1228 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and 1229 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of 1230 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5). 1231 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload) 1232 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier(); 1233 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1234 } 1235 return true; 1236 } 1237 1238 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member 1239 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static 1240 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this 1241 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod. 1242 auto OldQuals = OldMethod->getMethodQualifiers(); 1243 auto NewQuals = NewMethod->getMethodQualifiers(); 1244 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() && 1245 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 1246 NewQuals.addConst(); 1247 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'. 1248 OldQuals.removeRestrict(); 1249 NewQuals.removeRestrict(); 1250 if (OldQuals != NewQuals) 1251 return true; 1252 } 1253 1254 // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we 1255 // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function 1256 // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with 1257 // pass_object_size or it doesn't. 1258 if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) != 1259 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old)) 1260 return true; 1261 1262 // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature. 1263 for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> 1264 NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1265 NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(), 1266 OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1267 OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(); 1268 NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) { 1269 if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE) 1270 return true; 1271 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1272 NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true); 1273 OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true); 1274 if (NewID != OldID) 1275 return true; 1276 } 1277 1278 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) { 1279 // Don't allow overloading of destructors. (In theory we could, but it 1280 // would be a giant change to clang.) 1281 if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) { 1282 CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New), 1283 OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old); 1284 if (NewTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) { 1285 assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) && 1286 "Unexpected invalid target."); 1287 1288 // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA 1289 // target attributes. 1290 if (NewTarget != OldTarget) 1291 return true; 1292 } 1293 } 1294 } 1295 1296 if (ConsiderRequiresClauses) { 1297 Expr *NewRC = New->getTrailingRequiresClause(), 1298 *OldRC = Old->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 1299 if ((NewRC != nullptr) != (OldRC != nullptr)) 1300 // RC are most certainly different - these are overloads. 1301 return true; 1302 1303 if (NewRC) { 1304 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1305 NewRC->Profile(NewID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true); 1306 OldRC->Profile(OldID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true); 1307 if (NewID != OldID) 1308 // RCs are not equivalent - these are overloads. 1309 return true; 1310 } 1311 } 1312 1313 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 1314 return false; 1315 } 1316 1317 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType. 1318 /// 1319 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion 1320 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information. 1321 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1322 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1323 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1324 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1325 bool InOverloadResolution, 1326 bool CStyle, 1327 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1328 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1329 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1330 1331 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 1332 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 1333 // we can perform. 1334 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1335 return ICS; 1336 } 1337 1338 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 1339 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(), 1340 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1341 switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 1342 Conversions, AllowExplicit, 1343 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) { 1344 case OR_Success: 1345 case OR_Deleted: 1346 ICS.setUserDefined(); 1347 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1348 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1349 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1350 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1351 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 1352 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1353 // called for those cases. 1354 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 1355 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 1356 QualType FromCanon 1357 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 1358 QualType ToCanon 1359 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 1360 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 1361 (FromCanon == ToCanon || 1362 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 1363 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 1364 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 1365 DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction; 1366 ICS.setStandard(); 1367 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1368 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 1369 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1370 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 1371 ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found; 1372 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 1373 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1374 } 1375 } 1376 break; 1377 1378 case OR_Ambiguous: 1379 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 1380 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 1381 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 1382 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 1383 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 1384 if (Cand->Best) 1385 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 1386 break; 1387 1388 // Fall through. 1389 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 1390 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1391 break; 1392 } 1393 1394 return ICS; 1395 } 1396 1397 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 1398 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 1399 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 1400 /// to perform the initialization. Given 1401 /// 1402 /// void f(float f); 1403 /// void g(int i) { f(i); } 1404 /// 1405 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 1406 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 1407 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 1408 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 1409 // 1410 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 1411 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 1412 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 1413 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 1414 /// "BadConversion". 1415 /// 1416 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 1417 /// not permitted. 1418 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 1419 /// permitted. 1420 /// 1421 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C 1422 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to 1423 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments. 1424 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1425 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1426 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1427 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1428 bool InOverloadResolution, 1429 bool CStyle, 1430 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1431 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1432 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1433 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1434 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){ 1435 ICS.setStandard(); 1436 return ICS; 1437 } 1438 1439 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1440 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1441 return ICS; 1442 } 1443 1444 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1445 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1446 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1447 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1448 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 1449 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1450 // called for those cases. 1451 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1452 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 1453 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 1454 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType, ToType))) { 1455 ICS.setStandard(); 1456 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1457 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 1458 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1459 1460 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 1461 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 1462 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 1463 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 1464 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1465 1466 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 1467 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1468 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1469 1470 return ICS; 1471 } 1472 1473 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1474 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1475 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1476 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 1477 } 1478 1479 ImplicitConversionSequence 1480 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1481 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1482 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1483 bool InOverloadResolution, 1484 bool CStyle, 1485 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1486 return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1487 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1488 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1489 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1490 } 1491 1492 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 1493 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the 1494 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 1495 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 1496 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 1497 ExprResult Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1498 AssignmentAction Action, 1499 bool AllowExplicit) { 1500 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 1501 return ExprError(); 1502 1503 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion. 1504 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion 1505 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 1506 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending); 1507 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) 1508 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType, 1509 From->getType(), From); 1510 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion( 1511 *this, From, ToType, 1512 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 1513 AllowExplicit ? AllowedExplicit::All : AllowedExplicit::None, 1514 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 1515 /*CStyle=*/false, AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1516 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1517 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 1518 } 1519 1520 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1521 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function 1522 /// type. 1523 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1524 QualType &ResultTy) { 1525 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1526 return false; 1527 1528 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t) 1529 // or F(t noexcept) -> F(t) 1530 // where F adds one of the following at most once: 1531 // - a pointer 1532 // - a member pointer 1533 // - a block pointer 1534 // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType. 1535 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1536 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1537 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1538 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1539 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) { 1540 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) { 1541 CanTo = CanTo.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1542 CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1543 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) { 1544 CanTo = CanTo.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1545 CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1546 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) { 1547 auto ToMPT = CanTo.castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1548 auto FromMPT = CanFrom.castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1549 // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function. 1550 if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass()) 1551 return false; 1552 CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType(); 1553 CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType(); 1554 } else { 1555 return false; 1556 } 1557 1558 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1559 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1560 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) 1561 return false; 1562 } 1563 1564 const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom); 1565 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo(); 1566 1567 const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo); 1568 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo(); 1569 1570 bool Changed = false; 1571 1572 // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type. 1573 if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) { 1574 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false)); 1575 Changed = true; 1576 } 1577 1578 // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type. 1579 if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) { 1580 const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn); 1581 if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) { 1582 FromFn = cast<FunctionType>( 1583 Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0), 1584 EST_None) 1585 .getTypePtr()); 1586 Changed = true; 1587 } 1588 1589 // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid 1590 // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be 1591 // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list. 1592 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 1593 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 1594 if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT, 1595 CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) && 1596 CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) { 1597 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 1598 ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos = 1599 NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data(); 1600 QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(), 1601 FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo); 1602 FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>(); 1603 Changed = true; 1604 } 1605 } 1606 1607 if (!Changed) 1608 return false; 1609 1610 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical()); 1611 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false; 1612 1613 ResultTy = ToType; 1614 return true; 1615 } 1616 1617 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1618 /// vector conversion. 1619 /// 1620 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 1621 /// conversion. 1622 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType, 1623 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 1624 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 1625 // conversion. 1626 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 1627 return false; 1628 1629 // Identical types require no conversions. 1630 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1631 return false; 1632 1633 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 1634 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 1635 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 1636 // identity conversion. 1637 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 1638 return false; 1639 1640 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 1641 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 1642 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 1643 return true; 1644 } 1645 } 1646 1647 if (ToType->isSizelessBuiltinType() || FromType->isSizelessBuiltinType()) 1648 if (S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1649 S.Context.areLaxCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 1650 ICK = ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion; 1651 return true; 1652 } 1653 1654 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 1655 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 1656 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 1657 // same size 1658 // 3)the destination type does not have the ARM MVE strict-polymorphism 1659 // attribute, which inhibits lax vector conversion for overload resolution 1660 // only 1661 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 1662 if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1663 (S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType) && 1664 !ToType->hasAttr(attr::ArmMveStrictPolymorphism))) { 1665 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 1666 return true; 1667 } 1668 } 1669 1670 return false; 1671 } 1672 1673 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1674 bool InOverloadResolution, 1675 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1676 bool CStyle); 1677 1678 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 1679 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 1680 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 1681 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 1682 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 1683 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 1684 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 1685 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 1686 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 1687 bool InOverloadResolution, 1688 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1689 bool CStyle, 1690 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1691 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1692 1693 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 1694 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1695 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 1696 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1697 SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1698 1699 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 1700 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them. 1701 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1702 (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType())) 1703 return false; 1704 1705 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 1706 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 1707 // (C++ 4p1). 1708 1709 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1710 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 1711 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 1712 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 1713 AccessPair)) { 1714 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 1715 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 1716 FromType = Fn->getType(); 1717 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1718 1719 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check 1720 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool 1721 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1722 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) { 1723 QualType resultTy; 1724 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok 1725 if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, 1726 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy)) 1727 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard 1728 if (!ToType->isBooleanType()) 1729 return false; 1730 } 1731 1732 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded 1733 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the 1734 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of 1735 // expression. 1736 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn); 1737 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) { 1738 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) && 1739 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address"); 1740 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() 1741 == UO_AddrOf && 1742 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address"); 1743 const Type *ClassType 1744 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 1745 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 1746 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) { 1747 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() == 1748 UO_AddrOf && 1749 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression"); 1750 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1751 } 1752 1753 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 1754 // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't 1755 // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block. 1756 assert(S.Context.hasSameType( 1757 FromType, 1758 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 1759 } else { 1760 return false; 1761 } 1762 } 1763 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1): 1764 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can 1765 // be converted to a prvalue. 1766 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue(); 1767 if (argIsLValue && 1768 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 1769 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1770 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 1771 1772 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 1773 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 1774 // of the type of the lvalue ... 1775 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1776 FromType = Atomic->getValueType(); 1777 1778 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 1779 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 1780 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 1781 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 1782 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1783 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 1784 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 1785 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 1786 1787 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 1788 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 1789 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 1790 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 1791 1792 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 1793 // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4) 1794 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 1795 1796 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 1797 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 1798 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 1799 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 1800 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1801 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1802 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 1803 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 1804 return true; 1805 } 1806 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 1807 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 1808 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 1809 1810 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts())) 1811 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 1812 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 1813 return false; 1814 1815 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 1816 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 1817 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 1818 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1819 } else { 1820 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 1821 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 1822 } 1823 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 1824 1825 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 1826 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 1827 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 1828 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 1829 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 1830 // conversion. 1831 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 1832 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 1833 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 1834 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 1835 // conversion to do. 1836 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1837 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 1838 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 1839 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 1840 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1841 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1842 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 1843 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 1844 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1845 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1846 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 1847 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 1848 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1849 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 1850 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 1851 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 1852 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 1853 FromType->isMemberPointerType())) { 1854 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 1855 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 1856 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 1857 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1858 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 1859 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 1860 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 1861 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1862 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) { 1863 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 1864 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 1865 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1866 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 1867 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 1868 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 1869 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 1870 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1871 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 1872 // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if 1873 // their representation is different until there is back end support 1874 // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double. 1875 1876 // Conversions between bfloat and other floats are not permitted. 1877 if (FromType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty || ToType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty) 1878 return false; 1879 if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) != 1880 &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) { 1881 bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty && 1882 ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) || 1883 (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy && 1884 ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty)); 1885 if (Float128AndLongDouble && 1886 (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) == 1887 &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble())) 1888 return false; 1889 } 1890 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 1891 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 1892 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1893 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 1894 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 1895 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1896 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 1897 // Conversions between bfloat and int are not permitted. 1898 if (FromType->isBFloat16Type() || ToType->isBFloat16Type()) 1899 return false; 1900 1901 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 1902 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 1903 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1904 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1905 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion; 1906 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion && 1907 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1908 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion; 1909 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1910 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1911 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 1912 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 1913 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 1914 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1915 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 1916 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 1917 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 1918 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 1919 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 1920 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 1921 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1922 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1923 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 1924 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 1925 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1926 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1927 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, 1928 InOverloadResolution, 1929 SCS, CStyle)) { 1930 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion; 1931 FromType = ToType; 1932 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1933 CStyle)) { 1934 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence 1935 // appropriately. 1936 return true; 1937 } else if (ToType->isEventT() && 1938 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1939 From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) { 1940 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion; 1941 FromType = ToType; 1942 } else if (ToType->isQueueT() && 1943 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1944 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) { 1945 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion; 1946 FromType = ToType; 1947 } else if (ToType->isSamplerT() && 1948 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext())) { 1949 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1950 FromType = ToType; 1951 } else { 1952 // No second conversion required. 1953 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1954 } 1955 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 1956 1957 // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a 1958 // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]). 1959 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1960 if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1961 // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of 1962 // 'noreturn' (Clang extension). 1963 SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion; 1964 } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle, 1965 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) { 1966 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1967 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1968 FromType = ToType; 1969 } else { 1970 // No conversion required 1971 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1972 } 1973 1974 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 1975 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 1976 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 1977 // a conversion. [...] 1978 QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1979 QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1980 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 1981 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 1982 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) { 1983 FromType = ToType; 1984 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 1985 } 1986 1987 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 1988 1989 if (CanonFrom == CanonTo) 1990 return true; 1991 1992 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 1993 // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C. 1994 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution) 1995 return false; 1996 1997 ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From}; 1998 Sema::AssignConvertType Conv = 1999 S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER, 2000 /*Diagnose=*/false, 2001 /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, 2002 /*ConvertRHS=*/false); 2003 ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv; 2004 switch (Conv) { 2005 case Sema::Compatible: 2006 SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion; 2007 break; 2008 // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an 2009 // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop 2010 // qualifiers, as well. 2011 case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 2012 case Sema::IncompatiblePointer: 2013 case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign: 2014 SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 2015 break; 2016 default: 2017 return false; 2018 } 2019 2020 // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the 2021 // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the 2022 // function. 2023 SCS.Second = SecondConv; 2024 SCS.setToType(1, ToType); 2025 2026 // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other 2027 // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just 2028 // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything 2029 // from making this ICK_Qualification. 2030 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 2031 SCS.setToType(2, ToType); 2032 return true; 2033 } 2034 2035 static bool 2036 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 2037 QualType &ToType, 2038 bool InOverloadResolution, 2039 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 2040 bool CStyle) { 2041 2042 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType(); 2043 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 2044 return false; 2045 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 2046 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 2047 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 2048 for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) { 2049 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, 2050 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) { 2051 ToType = it->getType(); 2052 return true; 2053 } 2054 } 2055 return false; 2056 } 2057 2058 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 2059 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 2060 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 2061 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2062 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2063 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 2064 // All integers are built-in. 2065 if (!To) { 2066 return false; 2067 } 2068 2069 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 2070 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 2071 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 2072 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 2073 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 2074 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 2075 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 2076 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 2077 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 2078 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 2079 // less than int to an int. 2080 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) { 2081 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2082 } 2083 2084 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2085 } 2086 2087 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3: 2088 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 2089 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 2090 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 2091 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 2092 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 2093 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 2094 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 2095 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 2096 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 2097 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 2098 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 2099 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4: 2100 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed 2101 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if 2102 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an 2103 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be 2104 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type. 2105 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 2106 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 2107 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 2108 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 2109 return false; 2110 2111 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum, 2112 // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting 2113 // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider 2114 // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression. 2115 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) { 2116 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2117 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) || 2118 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType); 2119 } 2120 2121 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 2122 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 2123 isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType)) 2124 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 2125 ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 2126 2127 // C++ [conv.prom]p5: 2128 // If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other 2129 // value of that type for promotion purposes. 2130 // 2131 // ... so do not fall through into the bit-field checks below in C++. 2132 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2133 return false; 2134 } 2135 2136 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 2137 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 2138 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 2139 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 2140 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 2141 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 2142 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 2143 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 2144 // type. 2145 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 2146 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 2147 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 2148 // unsigned. 2149 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType(); 2150 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 2151 2152 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 2153 // order. Try each of these types. 2154 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 2155 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 2156 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 2157 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 2158 }; 2159 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 2160 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2161 if (FromSize < ToSize || 2162 (FromSize == ToSize && 2163 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 2164 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 2165 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 2166 // promotion. 2167 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2168 } 2169 } 2170 } 2171 2172 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 2173 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 2174 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 2175 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 2176 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 2177 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 2178 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 2179 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 2180 // conversion. 2181 // 2182 // FIXME: In C, only bit-fields of types _Bool, int, or unsigned int may be 2183 // promoted, per C11 6.3.1.1/2. We promote all bit-fields (including enum 2184 // bit-fields and those whose underlying type is larger than int) for GCC 2185 // compatibility. 2186 if (From) { 2187 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) { 2188 Optional<llvm::APSInt> BitWidth; 2189 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 2190 (BitWidth = 2191 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) { 2192 llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth->getBitWidth(), BitWidth->isUnsigned()); 2193 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 2194 2195 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 2196 if (*BitWidth < ToSize || 2197 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 2198 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2199 } 2200 2201 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 2202 // that fits into an unsigned int? 2203 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize) { 2204 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2205 } 2206 2207 return false; 2208 } 2209 } 2210 } 2211 2212 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 2213 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 2214 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 2215 return true; 2216 } 2217 2218 return false; 2219 } 2220 2221 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 2222 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 2223 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2224 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2225 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 2226 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 2227 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 2228 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 2229 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 2230 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 2231 return true; 2232 2233 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 2234 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 2235 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 2236 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2237 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 2238 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 2239 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble || 2240 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128)) 2241 return true; 2242 2243 // Half can be promoted to float. 2244 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 2245 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half && 2246 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) 2247 return true; 2248 } 2249 2250 return false; 2251 } 2252 2253 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 2254 /// 2255 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 2256 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 2257 /// floating-point or integral promotion. 2258 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2259 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2260 if (!FromComplex) 2261 return false; 2262 2263 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2264 if (!ToComplex) 2265 return false; 2266 2267 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 2268 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 2269 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(), 2270 ToComplex->getElementType()); 2271 } 2272 2273 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 2274 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 2275 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 2276 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 2277 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 2278 /// 2279 static QualType 2280 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 2281 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 2282 ASTContext &Context, 2283 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) { 2284 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 2285 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 2286 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 2287 2288 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 2289 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 2290 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2291 2292 QualType CanonFromPointee 2293 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 2294 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 2295 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2296 2297 if (StripObjCLifetime) 2298 Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2299 2300 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 2301 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 2302 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 2303 if (!ToType.isNull()) 2304 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2305 2306 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 2307 // already. 2308 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2309 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 2310 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 2311 } 2312 2313 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 2314 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 2315 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 2316 2317 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2318 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2319 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2320 } 2321 2322 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 2323 bool InOverloadResolution, 2324 ASTContext &Context) { 2325 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 2326 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 2327 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 2328 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 2329 return !InOverloadResolution; 2330 2331 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2332 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2333 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 2334 } 2335 2336 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2337 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 2338 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 2339 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 2340 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 2341 /// ConvertedType. 2342 /// 2343 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 2344 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 2345 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 2346 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 2347 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 2348 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 2349 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 2350 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 2351 /// should result in a warning. 2352 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2353 bool InOverloadResolution, 2354 QualType& ConvertedType, 2355 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2356 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2357 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, 2358 IncompatibleObjC)) 2359 return true; 2360 2361 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 2362 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 2363 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2364 ConvertedType = ToType; 2365 return true; 2366 } 2367 2368 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 2369 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 2370 ToType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 2371 ConvertedType = ToType; 2372 return true; 2373 } 2374 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 2375 // pointer type. 2376 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 2377 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2378 ConvertedType = ToType; 2379 return true; 2380 } 2381 2382 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 2383 // pointer constant. 2384 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 2385 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2386 ConvertedType = ToType; 2387 return true; 2388 } 2389 2390 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2391 if (!ToTypePtr) 2392 return false; 2393 2394 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 2395 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2396 ConvertedType = ToType; 2397 return true; 2398 } 2399 2400 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 2401 // , including objective-c pointers. 2402 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2403 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() && 2404 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2405 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 2406 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 2407 ToPointeeType, 2408 ToType, Context); 2409 return true; 2410 } 2411 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2412 if (!FromTypePtr) 2413 return false; 2414 2415 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2416 2417 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 2418 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 2419 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2420 return false; 2421 2422 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 2423 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 2424 // 4.10p2). 2425 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 2426 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2427 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2428 ToPointeeType, 2429 ToType, Context, 2430 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true); 2431 return true; 2432 } 2433 2434 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion. 2435 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && 2436 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2437 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2438 ToPointeeType, 2439 ToType, Context); 2440 return true; 2441 } 2442 2443 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 2444 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 2445 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2446 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2447 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2448 ToPointeeType, 2449 ToType, Context); 2450 return true; 2451 } 2452 2453 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 2454 // 2455 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 2456 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 2457 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 2458 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 2459 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 2460 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 2461 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 2462 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 2463 // 2464 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 2465 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 2466 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2467 ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2468 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 2469 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2470 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2471 ToPointeeType, 2472 ToType, Context); 2473 return true; 2474 } 2475 2476 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() && 2477 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2478 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2479 ToPointeeType, 2480 ToType, Context); 2481 return true; 2482 } 2483 2484 return false; 2485 } 2486 2487 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type. 2488 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){ 2489 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers(); 2490 2491 // Check whether qualifiers already match. 2492 if (TQs == Qs) 2493 return T; 2494 2495 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs)) 2496 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); 2497 2498 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 2499 } 2500 2501 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 2502 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 2503 /// with the same arguments and return values. 2504 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2505 QualType& ConvertedType, 2506 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2507 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC) 2508 return false; 2509 2510 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from. 2511 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2512 2513 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 2514 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = 2515 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2516 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 2517 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2518 2519 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 2520 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 2521 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 2522 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2523 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2524 return false; 2525 2526 // Conversion between Objective-C pointers. 2527 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 2528 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2529 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2530 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 2531 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 2532 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2533 return false; 2534 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2535 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2536 ToType, Context); 2537 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2538 return true; 2539 } 2540 2541 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 2542 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 2543 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 2544 // complain about it. 2545 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2546 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2547 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2548 ToType, Context); 2549 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2550 return true; 2551 } 2552 } 2553 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 2554 QualType ToPointeeType; 2555 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2556 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2557 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2558 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 2559 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 2560 // to a block pointer type. 2561 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2562 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2563 return true; 2564 } 2565 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2566 } 2567 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 2568 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2569 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 2570 // pointer to any object. 2571 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2572 return true; 2573 } 2574 else 2575 return false; 2576 2577 QualType FromPointeeType; 2578 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2579 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2580 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2581 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2582 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2583 else 2584 return false; 2585 2586 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 2587 // is an Objective-C conversion. 2588 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 2589 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2590 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2591 // We always complain about this conversion. 2592 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2593 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2594 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2595 return true; 2596 } 2597 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 2598 // as in I* to id. 2599 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2600 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2601 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2602 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2603 2604 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2605 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2606 return true; 2607 } 2608 2609 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 2610 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2611 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 2612 // complain about it). 2613 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2614 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2615 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2616 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2617 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 2618 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 2619 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 2620 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 2621 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 2622 return false; 2623 2624 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2625 // function types are obviously different. 2626 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2627 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 2628 FromFunctionType->getMethodQuals() != ToFunctionType->getMethodQuals()) 2629 return false; 2630 2631 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 2632 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) == 2633 Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2634 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2635 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2636 ToFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2637 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2638 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2639 HasObjCConversion = true; 2640 } else { 2641 // Function types are too different. Abort. 2642 return false; 2643 } 2644 2645 // Check argument types. 2646 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2647 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2648 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2649 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2650 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 2651 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 2652 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2653 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 2654 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2655 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2656 HasObjCConversion = true; 2657 } else { 2658 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2659 return false; 2660 } 2661 } 2662 2663 if (HasObjCConversion) { 2664 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 2665 // conversion, but complain about it. 2666 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2667 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2668 return true; 2669 } 2670 } 2671 2672 return false; 2673 } 2674 2675 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion, 2676 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting. 2677 /// 2678 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form. 2679 /// 2680 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to. 2681 /// 2682 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying 2683 /// this conversion. 2684 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2685 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2686 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || 2687 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 2688 return false; 2689 2690 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers). 2691 QualType ToPointee; 2692 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2693 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType(); 2694 else 2695 return false; 2696 2697 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers(); 2698 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2699 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing || 2700 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty()) 2701 return false; 2702 2703 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak. 2704 QualType FromPointee; 2705 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2706 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType(); 2707 else 2708 return false; 2709 2710 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2711 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2712 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 2713 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)) 2714 return false; 2715 2716 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers. 2717 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); 2718 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2719 return false; 2720 2721 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they 2722 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back 2723 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds. 2724 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2725 2726 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible. 2727 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2728 bool IncompatibleObjC; 2729 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee)) 2730 FromPointee = ToPointee; 2731 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee, 2732 IncompatibleObjC)) 2733 return false; 2734 2735 /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to 2736 /// __autoreleasing pointee. 2737 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals); 2738 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee); 2739 return true; 2740 } 2741 2742 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2743 QualType& ConvertedType) { 2744 QualType ToPointeeType; 2745 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2746 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2747 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2748 else 2749 return false; 2750 2751 QualType FromPointeeType; 2752 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2753 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2754 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2755 else 2756 return false; 2757 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only 2758 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2759 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion. 2760 2761 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2762 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2763 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2764 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2765 2766 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType) 2767 return false; 2768 2769 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2770 return true; 2771 2772 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2773 // function types are obviously different. 2774 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2775 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic()) 2776 return false; 2777 2778 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2779 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2780 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo) 2781 return false; 2782 2783 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 2784 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2785 ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2786 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2787 } else { 2788 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2789 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2790 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) && 2791 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()) 2792 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 2793 2794 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) { 2795 // OK exact match. 2796 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS, 2797 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2798 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2799 return false; 2800 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2801 } 2802 else 2803 return false; 2804 } 2805 2806 // Check argument types. 2807 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2808 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2809 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2810 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2811 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2812 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) { 2813 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2814 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType, 2815 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2816 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2817 return false; 2818 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2819 } else 2820 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2821 return false; 2822 } 2823 2824 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 2825 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 2826 if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType, 2827 CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT, 2828 NewParamInfos)) 2829 return false; 2830 2831 ConvertedType = ToType; 2832 return true; 2833 } 2834 2835 enum { 2836 ft_default, 2837 ft_different_class, 2838 ft_parameter_arity, 2839 ft_parameter_mismatch, 2840 ft_return_type, 2841 ft_qualifer_mismatch, 2842 ft_noexcept 2843 }; 2844 2845 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles 2846 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly. 2847 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) { 2848 if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 2849 return FPT; 2850 2851 if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 2852 return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2853 2854 return nullptr; 2855 } 2856 2857 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing 2858 /// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in 2859 /// parameter types, and different return types. 2860 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, 2861 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2862 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info. 2863 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) { 2864 PDiag << ft_default; 2865 return; 2866 } 2867 2868 // Get the function type from the pointers. 2869 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) { 2870 const auto *FromMember = FromType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(), 2871 *ToMember = ToType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2872 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) { 2873 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0) 2874 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0); 2875 return; 2876 } 2877 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType(); 2878 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType(); 2879 } 2880 2881 if (FromType->isPointerType()) 2882 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2883 if (ToType->isPointerType()) 2884 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType(); 2885 2886 // Remove references. 2887 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType(); 2888 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 2889 2890 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions. 2891 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() && 2892 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 2893 PDiag << ft_default; 2894 return; 2895 } 2896 2897 // No extra info for same types. 2898 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) { 2899 PDiag << ft_default; 2900 return; 2901 } 2902 2903 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType), 2904 *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType); 2905 2906 // Both types need to be function types. 2907 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) { 2908 PDiag << ft_default; 2909 return; 2910 } 2911 2912 if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) { 2913 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams() 2914 << FromFunction->getNumParams(); 2915 return; 2916 } 2917 2918 // Handle different parameter types. 2919 unsigned ArgPos; 2920 if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) { 2921 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1 2922 << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos) 2923 << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos); 2924 return; 2925 } 2926 2927 // Handle different return type. 2928 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(), 2929 ToFunction->getReturnType())) { 2930 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType() 2931 << FromFunction->getReturnType(); 2932 return; 2933 } 2934 2935 if (FromFunction->getMethodQuals() != ToFunction->getMethodQuals()) { 2936 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToFunction->getMethodQuals() 2937 << FromFunction->getMethodQuals(); 2938 return; 2939 } 2940 2941 // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17 2942 // onwards). 2943 if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2944 ->isNothrow() != 2945 cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2946 ->isNothrow()) { 2947 PDiag << ft_noexcept; 2948 return; 2949 } 2950 2951 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info. 2952 PDiag << ft_default; 2953 } 2954 2955 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 2956 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 2957 /// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different, 2958 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter. 2959 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType, 2960 const FunctionProtoType *NewType, 2961 unsigned *ArgPos) { 2962 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(), 2963 N = NewType->param_type_begin(), 2964 E = OldType->param_type_end(); 2965 O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 2966 // Ignore address spaces in pointee type. This is to disallow overloading 2967 // on __ptr32/__ptr64 address spaces. 2968 QualType Old = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(O->getUnqualifiedType()); 2969 QualType New = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(N->getUnqualifiedType()); 2970 2971 if (!Context.hasSameType(Old, New)) { 2972 if (ArgPos) 2973 *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin(); 2974 return false; 2975 } 2976 } 2977 return true; 2978 } 2979 2980 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 2981 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 2982 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 2983 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 2984 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 2985 /// error, or returns false otherwise. 2986 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2987 CastKind &Kind, 2988 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 2989 bool IgnoreBaseAccess, 2990 bool Diagnose) { 2991 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2992 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 2993 2994 Kind = CK_BitCast; 2995 2996 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() && 2997 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) == 2998 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) { 2999 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy)) 3000 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From, 3001 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer) 3002 << ToType << From->getSourceRange()); 3003 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) 3004 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer) 3005 << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3006 } 3007 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3008 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3009 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 3010 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 3011 3012 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 3013 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 3014 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 3015 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 3016 unsigned InaccessibleID = 0; 3017 unsigned AmbiguousID = 0; 3018 if (Diagnose) { 3019 InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base; 3020 AmbiguousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv; 3021 } 3022 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion( 3023 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbiguousID, 3024 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(), 3025 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess)) 3026 return true; 3027 3028 // The conversion was successful. 3029 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 3030 } 3031 3032 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && 3033 FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 3034 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 3035 "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!"); 3036 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj) 3037 << From->getSourceRange(); 3038 } 3039 } 3040 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 3041 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3042 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 3043 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3044 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 3045 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 3046 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 3047 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 3048 return false; 3049 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) { 3050 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 3051 } else { 3052 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 3053 } 3054 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) { 3055 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType()) 3056 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 3057 } 3058 3059 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 3060 // reasons. 3061 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 3062 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 3063 3064 return false; 3065 } 3066 3067 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 3068 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 3069 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 3070 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 3071 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 3072 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 3073 QualType ToType, 3074 bool InOverloadResolution, 3075 QualType &ConvertedType) { 3076 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3077 if (!ToTypePtr) 3078 return false; 3079 3080 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 3081 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 3082 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 3083 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 3084 ConvertedType = ToType; 3085 return true; 3086 } 3087 3088 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 3089 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3090 if (!FromTypePtr) 3091 return false; 3092 3093 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 3094 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 3095 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 3096 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 3097 3098 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) && 3099 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass)) { 3100 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 3101 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 3102 return true; 3103 } 3104 3105 return false; 3106 } 3107 3108 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 3109 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 3110 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 3111 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 3112 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 3113 /// otherwise. 3114 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3115 CastKind &Kind, 3116 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 3117 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 3118 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 3119 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3120 if (!FromPtrType) { 3121 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 3122 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 3123 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 3124 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 3125 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 3126 return false; 3127 } 3128 3129 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3130 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 3131 "that is not a member pointer."); 3132 3133 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3134 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3135 3136 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 3137 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3138 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3139 3140 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 3141 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 3142 bool DerivationOkay = 3143 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 3144 assert(DerivationOkay && 3145 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 3146 (void)DerivationOkay; 3147 3148 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 3149 getUnqualifiedType())) { 3150 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 3151 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 3152 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 3153 return true; 3154 } 3155 3156 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 3157 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 3158 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 3159 << From->getSourceRange(); 3160 return true; 3161 } 3162 3163 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 3164 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 3165 Paths.front(), 3166 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 3167 3168 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 3169 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 3170 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 3171 return false; 3172 } 3173 3174 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given 3175 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial. 3176 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals, 3177 Qualifiers ToQuals) { 3178 // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial. 3179 if (ToQuals.hasConst() && 3180 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) 3181 return false; 3182 3183 return true; 3184 } 3185 3186 /// Perform a single iteration of the loop for checking if a qualification 3187 /// conversion is valid. 3188 /// 3189 /// Specifically, check whether any change between the qualifiers of \p 3190 /// FromType and \p ToType is permissible, given knowledge about whether every 3191 /// outer layer is const-qualified. 3192 static bool isQualificationConversionStep(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3193 bool CStyle, bool IsTopLevel, 3194 bool &PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, 3195 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3196 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers(); 3197 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers(); 3198 3199 // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void. 3200 if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType()) 3201 FromQuals.removeUnaligned(); 3202 3203 // Objective-C ARC: 3204 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions. 3205 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime()) { 3206 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) { 3207 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals)) 3208 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 3209 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3210 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3211 } else { 3212 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different 3213 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers. 3214 return false; 3215 } 3216 } 3217 3218 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes. 3219 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() && 3220 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) { 3221 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3222 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3223 } 3224 3225 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 3226 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 3227 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 3228 return false; 3229 3230 // If address spaces mismatch: 3231 // - in top level it is only valid to convert to addr space that is a 3232 // superset in all cases apart from C-style casts where we allow 3233 // conversions between overlapping address spaces. 3234 // - in non-top levels it is not a valid conversion. 3235 if (ToQuals.getAddressSpace() != FromQuals.getAddressSpace() && 3236 (!IsTopLevel || 3237 !(ToQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(FromQuals) || 3238 (CStyle && FromQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(ToQuals))))) 3239 return false; 3240 3241 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 3242 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 3243 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() && 3244 !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 3245 return false; 3246 3247 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 3248 // include const. 3249 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = 3250 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst(); 3251 return true; 3252 } 3253 3254 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 3255 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 3256 /// (C++ 4.4). 3257 /// 3258 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate 3259 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C 3260 /// object lifetime. 3261 bool 3262 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3263 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3264 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 3265 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 3266 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3267 3268 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 3269 // qualification conversion. 3270 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 3271 return false; 3272 3273 // (C++ 4.4p4): 3274 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 3275 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 3276 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 3277 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 3278 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 3279 if (!isQualificationConversionStep( 3280 FromType, ToType, CStyle, !UnwrappedAnyPointer, 3281 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 3282 return false; 3283 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 3284 } 3285 3286 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 3287 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 3288 // of times. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 3289 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 3290 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 3291 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 3292 } 3293 3294 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an 3295 /// atomic type. 3296 /// 3297 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion 3298 /// sequence to finish the conversion. 3299 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3300 bool InOverloadResolution, 3301 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 3302 bool CStyle) { 3303 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>(); 3304 if (!ToAtomic) 3305 return false; 3306 3307 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS; 3308 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(), 3309 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS, 3310 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) 3311 return false; 3312 3313 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second; 3314 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1)); 3315 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third; 3316 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3317 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime; 3318 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2)); 3319 return true; 3320 } 3321 3322 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context, 3323 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, 3324 QualType Type) { 3325 const auto *CtorType = Constructor->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3326 if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) { 3327 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0); 3328 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType())) 3329 return true; 3330 } 3331 return false; 3332 } 3333 3334 static OverloadingResult 3335 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3336 CXXRecordDecl *To, 3337 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3338 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3339 bool AllowExplicit) { 3340 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3341 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) { 3342 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3343 if (!Info) 3344 continue; 3345 3346 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 3347 S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor); 3348 if (Usable) { 3349 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3350 // suppress conversions. 3351 bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3352 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3353 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3354 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3355 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From, 3356 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3357 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3358 AllowExplicit); 3359 else 3360 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From, 3361 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3362 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit); 3363 } 3364 } 3365 3366 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3367 3368 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3369 switch (auto Result = 3370 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) { 3371 case OR_Deleted: 3372 case OR_Success: { 3373 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3374 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function); 3375 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(); 3376 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3377 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3378 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3379 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3380 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3381 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3382 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3383 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3384 return Result; 3385 } 3386 3387 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3388 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3389 case OR_Ambiguous: 3390 return OR_Ambiguous; 3391 } 3392 3393 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3394 } 3395 3396 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 3397 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 3398 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 3399 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 3400 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 3401 /// false and User is unspecified. 3402 /// 3403 /// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 3404 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 3405 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 3406 /// 3407 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should 3408 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit 3409 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set. 3410 static OverloadingResult 3411 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3412 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3413 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3414 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 3415 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 3416 assert(AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None || 3417 !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3418 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3419 3420 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 3421 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 3422 3423 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 3424 // constructors. 3425 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3426 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 3427 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 3428 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 3429 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 3430 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 3431 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 3432 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 3433 // the parentheses of the initializer. 3434 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 3435 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 3436 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), ToType))) 3437 ConstructorsOnly = true; 3438 3439 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) { 3440 // We're not going to find any constructors. 3441 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 3442 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 3443 3444 Expr **Args = &From; 3445 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 3446 bool ListInitializing = false; 3447 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3448 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work. 3449 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion( 3450 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, 3451 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3452 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function) 3453 return Result; 3454 // Never mind. 3455 CandidateSet.clear( 3456 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3457 3458 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as 3459 // arguments, not the entire list. 3460 Args = InitList->getInits(); 3461 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits(); 3462 ListInitializing = true; 3463 } 3464 3465 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) { 3466 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3467 if (!Info) 3468 continue; 3469 3470 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl(); 3471 if (!ListInitializing) 3472 Usable = Usable && Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor( 3473 /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 3474 if (Usable) { 3475 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly; 3476 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) { 3477 SuppressUserConversions = false; 3478 if (NumArgs == 1) { 3479 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3480 // suppress conversions. 3481 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3482 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3483 } 3484 } 3485 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3486 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 3487 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3488 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3489 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3490 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3491 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3492 else 3493 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 3494 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 3495 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, 3496 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3497 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3498 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3499 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3500 } 3501 } 3502 } 3503 } 3504 3505 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 3506 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3507 } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType())) { 3508 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 3509 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType = 3510 From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3511 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 3512 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 3513 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 3514 const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 3515 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 3516 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 3517 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 3518 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 3519 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 3520 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 3521 3522 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 3523 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 3524 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 3525 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 3526 else 3527 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 3528 3529 if (ConvTemplate) 3530 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 3531 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, 3532 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 3533 AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None); 3534 else 3535 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, 3536 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 3537 AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None); 3538 } 3539 } 3540 } 3541 3542 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3543 3544 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3545 switch (auto Result = 3546 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) { 3547 case OR_Success: 3548 case OR_Deleted: 3549 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3550 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 3551 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3552 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3553 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3554 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 3555 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 3556 // the argument of the constructor. 3557 // 3558 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(); 3559 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3560 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3561 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3562 } else { 3563 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 3564 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 3565 else { 3566 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3567 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3568 } 3569 } 3570 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3571 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3572 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3573 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3574 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3575 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3576 return Result; 3577 } 3578 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3579 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3580 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3581 // 3582 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3583 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 3584 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 3585 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 3586 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3587 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3588 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 3589 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3590 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3591 3592 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 3593 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 3594 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 3595 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 3596 // is an initialization, the special rules for 3597 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 3598 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 3599 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 3600 // 13.3.3.1). 3601 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 3602 return Result; 3603 } 3604 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 3605 3606 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3607 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3608 3609 case OR_Ambiguous: 3610 return OR_Ambiguous; 3611 } 3612 3613 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3614 } 3615 3616 bool 3617 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 3618 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3619 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(), 3620 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 3621 OverloadingResult OvResult = 3622 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 3623 CandidateSet, AllowedExplicit::None, false); 3624 3625 if (!(OvResult == OR_Ambiguous || 3626 (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()))) 3627 return false; 3628 3629 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates( 3630 *this, 3631 OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ? OCD_AmbiguousCandidates : OCD_AllCandidates, 3632 From); 3633 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 3634 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 3635 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3636 else { // OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty() 3637 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType, 3638 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete, 3639 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange())) 3640 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 3641 << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType; 3642 } 3643 3644 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 3645 *this, From, Cands); 3646 return true; 3647 } 3648 3649 // Helper for compareConversionFunctions that gets the FunctionType that the 3650 // conversion-operator return value 'points' to, or nullptr. 3651 static const FunctionType * 3652 getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(CXXConversionDecl *Conv) { 3653 const FunctionType *ConvFuncTy = Conv->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3654 const PointerType *RetPtrTy = 3655 ConvFuncTy->getReturnType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 3656 3657 if (!RetPtrTy) 3658 return nullptr; 3659 3660 return RetPtrTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3661 } 3662 3663 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors 3664 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering 3665 /// is possible. 3666 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3667 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1, 3668 FunctionDecl *Function2) { 3669 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1); 3670 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2); 3671 if (!Conv1 || !Conv2) 3672 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3673 3674 if (!Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() || !Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) 3675 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3676 3677 // Objective-C++: 3678 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from 3679 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer, 3680 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer, 3681 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely 3682 // to keep code working. 3683 if (S.getLangOpts().ObjC && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 3684 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3685 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3686 if (Block1 != Block2) 3687 return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3688 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3689 } 3690 3691 // In order to support multiple calling conventions for the lambda conversion 3692 // operator (such as when the free and member function calling convention is 3693 // different), prefer the 'free' mechanism, followed by the calling-convention 3694 // of operator(). The latter is in place to support the MSVC-like solution of 3695 // defining ALL of the possible conversions in regards to calling-convention. 3696 const FunctionType *Conv1FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv1); 3697 const FunctionType *Conv2FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv2); 3698 3699 if (Conv1FuncRet && Conv2FuncRet && 3700 Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv() != Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv()) { 3701 CallingConv Conv1CC = Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv(); 3702 CallingConv Conv2CC = Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv(); 3703 3704 CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = Conv2->getParent()->getLambdaCallOperator(); 3705 const FunctionProtoType *CallOpProto = 3706 CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3707 3708 CallingConv CallOpCC = 3709 CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 3710 CallingConv DefaultFree = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention( 3711 CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/false); 3712 CallingConv DefaultMember = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention( 3713 CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/true); 3714 3715 CallingConv PrefOrder[] = {DefaultFree, DefaultMember, CallOpCC}; 3716 for (CallingConv CC : PrefOrder) { 3717 if (Conv1CC == CC) 3718 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3719 if (Conv2CC == CC) 3720 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3721 } 3722 } 3723 3724 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3725 } 3726 3727 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion( 3728 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 3729 return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) || 3730 (ICS.isUserDefined() && 3731 ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr); 3732 } 3733 3734 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 3735 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3736 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 3737 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3738 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3739 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 3740 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 3741 { 3742 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 3743 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 3744 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 3745 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 3746 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 3747 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 3748 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 3749 // (13.3.3.1.3). 3750 // 3751 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 3752 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 3753 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 3754 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 3755 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 3756 3757 // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has 3758 // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at 3759 // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse 3760 // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the 3761 // standard. For example: 3762 // 3763 // int &f(...); // #1 3764 // void f(char*); // #2 3765 // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); } 3766 // 3767 // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function. 3768 // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis 3769 // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there 3770 // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't 3771 // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11. 3772 // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued 3773 // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11. 3774 3775 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 3776 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) != 3777 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2)) 3778 return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) 3779 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3780 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3781 3782 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 3783 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3784 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 3785 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3786 3787 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 3788 // the same kind. 3789 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 3790 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3791 3792 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 3793 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3794 3795 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 3796 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 3797 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3798 3799 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than 3800 // list-initialization sequence L2 if: 3801 // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or, 3802 // if not that, 3803 // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T", 3804 // and N1 is smaller than N2., 3805 // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply. 3806 if (!ICS1.isBad()) { 3807 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3808 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3809 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3810 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3811 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3812 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3813 } 3814 3815 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 3816 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than 3817 // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...] 3818 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3819 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 3820 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 3821 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 3822 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 3823 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 3824 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 3825 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 3826 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3827 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 3828 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 3829 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3830 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 3831 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 3832 else 3833 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S, 3834 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction, 3835 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 3836 } 3837 3838 return Result; 3839 } 3840 3841 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 3842 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 3843 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3844 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 3845 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3846 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3847 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3848 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3849 3850 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 3851 // any non-identity conversion sequence 3852 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3853 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3854 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3855 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3856 3857 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 3858 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 3859 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3860 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 3861 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3862 else 3863 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3864 } else if (!Context.hasSimilarType(SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 3865 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3866 3867 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 3868 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 3869 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3870 } 3871 3872 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 3873 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3874 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3875 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3876 3877 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 3878 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3879 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3880 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3881 3882 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3883 } 3884 3885 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better 3886 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are. 3887 static bool 3888 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1, 3889 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) { 3890 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3891 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 3892 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 3893 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference 3894 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an 3895 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue 3896 // reference*. 3897 // 3898 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits, 3899 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the 3900 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward 3901 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions. 3902 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration. 3903 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier || 3904 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier) 3905 return false; 3906 3907 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue && 3908 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) || 3909 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue && 3910 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue); 3911 } 3912 3913 enum class FixedEnumPromotion { 3914 None, 3915 ToUnderlyingType, 3916 ToPromotedUnderlyingType 3917 }; 3918 3919 /// Returns kind of fixed enum promotion the \a SCS uses. 3920 static FixedEnumPromotion 3921 getFixedEnumPromtion(Sema &S, const StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 3922 3923 if (SCS.Second != ICK_Integral_Promotion) 3924 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3925 3926 QualType FromType = SCS.getFromType(); 3927 if (!FromType->isEnumeralType()) 3928 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3929 3930 EnumDecl *Enum = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl(); 3931 if (!Enum->isFixed()) 3932 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3933 3934 QualType UnderlyingType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 3935 if (S.Context.hasSameType(SCS.getToType(1), UnderlyingType)) 3936 return FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType; 3937 3938 return FixedEnumPromotion::ToPromotedUnderlyingType; 3939 } 3940 3941 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 3942 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3943 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3944 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3945 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3946 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3947 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 3948 { 3949 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 3950 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3951 3952 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 3953 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 3954 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 3955 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 3956 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 3957 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 3958 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 3959 return CK; 3960 3961 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 3962 // defined below), or, if not that, 3963 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 3964 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 3965 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 3966 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3967 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 3968 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3969 3970 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 3971 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 3972 // applies: 3973 3974 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 3975 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 3976 // that is such a conversion. 3977 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 3978 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 3979 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3980 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3981 3982 // C++14 [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3983 // This is retroactively applied to C++11 by CWG 1601. 3984 // 3985 // A conversion that promotes an enumeration whose underlying type is fixed 3986 // to its underlying type is better than one that promotes to the promoted 3987 // underlying type, if the two are different. 3988 FixedEnumPromotion FEP1 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS1); 3989 FixedEnumPromotion FEP2 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS2); 3990 if (FEP1 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && FEP2 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && 3991 FEP1 != FEP2) 3992 return FEP1 == FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType 3993 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3994 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3995 3996 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3997 // 3998 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 3999 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 4000 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 4001 // of B* to void*. 4002 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 4003 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 4004 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 4005 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 4006 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 4007 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 4008 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 4009 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4010 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4011 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 4012 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 4013 // their derived-to-base conversions. 4014 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 4015 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2)) 4016 return DerivedCK; 4017 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid && 4018 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) { 4019 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 4020 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 4021 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 4022 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 4023 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 4024 4025 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 4026 // conversion, if we need to. 4027 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4028 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 4029 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4030 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 4031 4032 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4033 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4034 4035 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4036 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4037 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4038 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4039 4040 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 4041 // other, it is the better one. 4042 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1 4043 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4044 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2 4045 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4046 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) { 4047 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1, 4048 FromObjCPtr2); 4049 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2, 4050 FromObjCPtr1); 4051 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) { 4052 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4053 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4054 } 4055 } 4056 } 4057 4058 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 4059 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings. 4060 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2)) 4061 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4062 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1)) 4063 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4064 } 4065 4066 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 4067 // bullet 3). 4068 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 4069 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 4070 return QualCK; 4071 4072 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 4073 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 4074 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 4075 // which the references refer are the same type except for 4076 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 4077 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 4078 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 4079 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 4080 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 4081 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 4082 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 4083 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4084 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4085 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4086 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4087 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different 4088 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime. 4089 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding != 4090 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) { 4091 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding 4092 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4093 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4094 } 4095 4096 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the 4097 // type for comparison. 4098 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 4099 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 4100 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 4101 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 4102 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 4103 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4104 if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 4105 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4106 } 4107 } 4108 4109 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a 4110 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion 4111 // is between types of the same size. 4112 // For example: 4113 // void f(float); 4114 // void f(int); 4115 // int main { 4116 // long a; 4117 // f(a); 4118 // } 4119 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error 4120 // as clang will do in standard mode. 4121 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion && 4122 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral && 4123 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) == 4124 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2))) 4125 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4126 4127 // Prefer a compatible vector conversion over a lax vector conversion 4128 // For example: 4129 // 4130 // typedef float __v4sf __attribute__((__vector_size__(16))); 4131 // void f(vector float); 4132 // void f(vector signed int); 4133 // int main() { 4134 // __v4sf a; 4135 // f(a); 4136 // } 4137 // Here, we'd like to choose f(vector float) and not 4138 // report an ambiguous call error 4139 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion && 4140 SCS2.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion) { 4141 bool SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes( 4142 SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2)); 4143 bool SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes( 4144 SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2)); 4145 4146 if (SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion != SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion) 4147 return SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion 4148 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4149 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4150 } 4151 4152 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion && 4153 SCS2.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion) { 4154 bool SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion = 4155 S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2)); 4156 bool SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion = 4157 S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2)); 4158 4159 if (SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion != 4160 SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion) 4161 return SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion 4162 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4163 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4164 } 4165 4166 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4167 } 4168 4169 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 4170 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4171 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 4172 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4173 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 4174 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4175 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4176 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 4177 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 4178 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 4179 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 4180 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 4181 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 4182 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 4183 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 4184 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4185 4186 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 4187 // conversion (!) 4188 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 4189 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 4190 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 4191 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 4192 assert(!T1->isReferenceType() && !T2->isReferenceType()); 4193 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4194 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4195 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4196 4197 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapping 4198 // them. 4199 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 4200 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4201 4202 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 4203 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4204 4205 // Objective-C++ ARC: 4206 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime 4207 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime. 4208 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime != 4209 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) { 4210 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 4211 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4212 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4213 } 4214 4215 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) { 4216 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 4217 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 4218 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 4219 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 4220 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 4221 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 4222 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 4223 // strict subset of qualifiers. 4224 if (T1.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime() == 4225 T2.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime()) 4226 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 4227 // about how the sequences rank. 4228 // ObjC ownership quals are omitted above as they interfere with 4229 // the ARC overload rule. 4230 ; 4231 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 4232 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 4233 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 4234 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 4235 // qualifiers. 4236 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4237 4238 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4239 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 4240 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 4241 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 4242 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 4243 // qualifiers. 4244 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4245 4246 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4247 } else { 4248 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 4249 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4250 } 4251 4252 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 4253 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 4254 break; 4255 } 4256 4257 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 4258 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 4259 switch (Result) { 4260 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 4261 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 4262 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4263 break; 4264 4265 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 4266 break; 4267 4268 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 4269 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 4270 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4271 break; 4272 } 4273 4274 return Result; 4275 } 4276 4277 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 4278 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4279 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 4280 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 4281 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 4282 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4283 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 4284 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4285 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4286 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 4287 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 4288 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 4289 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 4290 4291 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 4292 // conversion, if we need to. 4293 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4294 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 4295 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4296 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 4297 4298 // Canonicalize all of the types. 4299 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 4300 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 4301 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 4302 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 4303 4304 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 4305 // 4306 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 4307 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 4308 // 4309 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 4310 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4311 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4312 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 4313 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 4314 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 4315 QualType FromPointee1 = 4316 FromType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4317 QualType ToPointee1 = 4318 ToType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4319 QualType FromPointee2 = 4320 FromType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4321 QualType ToPointee2 = 4322 ToType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4323 4324 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4325 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4326 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4327 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4328 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4329 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4330 } 4331 4332 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4333 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 4334 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4335 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4336 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4337 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4338 } 4339 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4340 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 4341 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1 4342 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4343 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2 4344 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4345 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1 4346 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4347 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2 4348 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4349 4350 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) { 4351 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types 4352 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the 4353 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of 4354 // Objective-C pointer types. 4355 bool FromAssignLeft 4356 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2); 4357 bool FromAssignRight 4358 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1); 4359 bool ToAssignLeft 4360 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2); 4361 bool ToAssignRight 4362 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1); 4363 4364 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id' 4365 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'. 4366 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() && 4367 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4368 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4369 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() && 4370 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4371 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4372 4373 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a 4374 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type 4375 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4376 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4377 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4378 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4379 4380 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class' 4381 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'. 4382 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4383 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4384 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4385 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() && 4386 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4387 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4388 4389 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a 4390 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type. 4391 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4392 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4393 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4394 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4395 4396 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4397 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4398 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4399 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) { 4400 if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) { 4401 // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to 4402 // C *. 4403 bool IsFirstSame = 4404 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl(); 4405 bool IsSecondSame = 4406 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl(); 4407 if (IsFirstSame) { 4408 if (!IsSecondSame) 4409 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4410 } else if (IsSecondSame) 4411 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4412 } 4413 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4414 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4415 } 4416 4417 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4418 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) && 4419 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight)) 4420 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4421 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4422 } 4423 } 4424 4425 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 4426 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 4427 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 4428 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 4429 const auto *FromMemPointer1 = FromType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4430 const auto *ToMemPointer1 = ToType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4431 const auto *FromMemPointer2 = FromType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4432 const auto *ToMemPointer2 = ToType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4433 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 4434 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 4435 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 4436 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 4437 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4438 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4439 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4440 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4441 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 4442 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4443 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4444 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4445 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4446 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4447 } 4448 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 4449 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 4450 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4451 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4452 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4453 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4454 } 4455 } 4456 4457 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 4458 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 4459 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 4460 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4461 // reference of type A&, 4462 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4463 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4464 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2)) 4465 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4466 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1)) 4467 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4468 } 4469 4470 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 4471 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 4472 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4473 // reference of type A&, 4474 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4475 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4476 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1)) 4477 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4478 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2)) 4479 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4480 } 4481 } 4482 4483 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4484 } 4485 4486 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid 4487 /// C++ class. 4488 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) { 4489 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 4490 return !Record->isInvalidDecl(); 4491 4492 return true; 4493 } 4494 4495 static QualType withoutUnaligned(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) { 4496 if (!T.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned()) 4497 return T; 4498 4499 Qualifiers Q; 4500 T = Ctx.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T, Q); 4501 Q.removeUnaligned(); 4502 return Ctx.getQualifiedType(T, Q); 4503 } 4504 4505 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 4506 /// determine whether they are reference-compatible, 4507 /// reference-related, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 4508 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 4509 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 4510 /// type being initialized. 4511 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 4512 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 4513 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 4514 ReferenceConversions *ConvOut) { 4515 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 4516 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 4517 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 4518 4519 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 4520 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 4521 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4522 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4523 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4524 4525 ReferenceConversions ConvTmp; 4526 ReferenceConversions &Conv = ConvOut ? *ConvOut : ConvTmp; 4527 Conv = ReferenceConversions(); 4528 4529 // C++2a [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4530 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 4531 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is similar to T2, or 4532 // T1 is a base class of T2. 4533 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if 4534 // a prvalue of type "pointer to cv2 T2" can be converted to the type 4535 // "pointer to cv1 T1" via a standard conversion sequence. 4536 4537 // Check for standard conversions we can apply to pointers: derived-to-base 4538 // conversions, ObjC pointer conversions, and function pointer conversions. 4539 // (Qualification conversions are checked last.) 4540 QualType ConvertedT2; 4541 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4542 // Nothing to do. 4543 } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) && 4544 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) && 4545 IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 4546 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase; 4547 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4548 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4549 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 4550 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjC; 4551 else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() && 4552 IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) { 4553 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Function; 4554 // No need to check qualifiers; function types don't have them. 4555 return Ref_Compatible; 4556 } 4557 bool ConvertedReferent = Conv != 0; 4558 4559 // We can have a qualification conversion. Compute whether the types are 4560 // similar at the same time. 4561 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 4562 bool TopLevel = true; 4563 do { 4564 if (T1 == T2) 4565 break; 4566 4567 // We will need a qualification conversion. 4568 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Qualification; 4569 4570 // Track whether we performed a qualification conversion anywhere other 4571 // than the top level. This matters for ranking reference bindings in 4572 // overload resolution. 4573 if (!TopLevel) 4574 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification; 4575 4576 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4577 T1 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T1); 4578 T2 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T2); 4579 4580 // If we find a qualifier mismatch, the types are not reference-compatible, 4581 // but are still be reference-related if they're similar. 4582 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4583 if (!isQualificationConversionStep(T2, T1, /*CStyle=*/false, TopLevel, 4584 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, 4585 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 4586 return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSimilarType(T1, T2)) 4587 ? Ref_Related 4588 : Ref_Incompatible; 4589 4590 // FIXME: Should we track this for any level other than the first? 4591 if (ObjCLifetimeConversion) 4592 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime; 4593 4594 TopLevel = false; 4595 } while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)); 4596 4597 // At this point, if the types are reference-related, we must either have the 4598 // same inner type (ignoring qualifiers), or must have already worked out how 4599 // to convert the referent. 4600 return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 4601 ? Ref_Compatible 4602 : Ref_Incompatible; 4603 } 4604 4605 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible 4606 /// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 4607 static bool 4608 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 4609 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4610 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 4611 bool AllowExplicit) { 4612 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 4613 auto *T2RecordDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 4614 4615 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 4616 DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 4617 const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4618 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 4619 NamedDecl *D = *I; 4620 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 4621 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 4622 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 4623 4624 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 4625 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 4626 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 4627 if (ConvTemplate) 4628 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 4629 else 4630 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 4631 4632 if (AllowRvalues) { 4633 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion 4634 // functions that return lvalues. 4635 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 4636 const ReferenceType *RefType 4637 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4638 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 4639 continue; 4640 } 4641 4642 if (!ConvTemplate && 4643 S.CompareReferenceRelationship( 4644 DeclLoc, 4645 Conv->getConversionType() 4646 .getNonReferenceType() 4647 .getUnqualifiedType(), 4648 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType()) == 4649 Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 4650 continue; 4651 } else { 4652 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 4653 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 4654 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 4655 4656 const ReferenceType *RefType = 4657 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 4658 if (!RefType || 4659 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 4660 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 4661 continue; 4662 } 4663 4664 if (ConvTemplate) 4665 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 4666 ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4667 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit); 4668 else 4669 S.AddConversionCandidate( 4670 Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4671 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit); 4672 } 4673 4674 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 4675 4676 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4677 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) { 4678 case OR_Success: 4679 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4680 // 4681 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 4682 // applying a conversion function to the argument 4683 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 4684 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 4685 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 4686 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 4687 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 4688 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 4689 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 4690 return false; 4691 4692 ICS.setUserDefined(); 4693 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 4694 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 4695 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 4696 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 4697 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 4698 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 4699 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 4700 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 4701 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 4702 return true; 4703 4704 case OR_Ambiguous: 4705 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 4706 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 4707 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 4708 if (Cand->Best) 4709 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 4710 return true; 4711 4712 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 4713 case OR_Deleted: 4714 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 4715 // conversion; continue with other checks. 4716 return false; 4717 } 4718 4719 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 4720 } 4721 4722 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 4723 /// initialization. 4724 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4725 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType, 4726 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4727 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4728 bool AllowExplicit) { 4729 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 4730 4731 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 4732 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4733 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4734 4735 QualType T1 = DeclType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4736 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4737 4738 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4739 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4740 // type of the resulting function. 4741 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4742 DeclAccessPair Found; 4743 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 4744 false, Found)) 4745 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4746 } 4747 4748 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4749 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 4750 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 4751 4752 Sema::ReferenceConversions RefConv; 4753 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship = 4754 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, &RefConv); 4755 4756 auto SetAsReferenceBinding = [&](bool BindsDirectly) { 4757 ICS.setStandard(); 4758 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4759 // FIXME: A reference binding can be a function conversion too. We should 4760 // consider that when ordering reference-to-function bindings. 4761 ICS.Standard.Second = (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase) 4762 ? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4763 : (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjC) 4764 ? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4765 : ICK_Identity; 4766 // FIXME: As a speculative fix to a defect introduced by CWG2352, we rank 4767 // a reference binding that performs a non-top-level qualification 4768 // conversion as a qualification conversion, not as an identity conversion. 4769 ICS.Standard.Third = (RefConv & 4770 Sema::ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification) 4771 ? ICK_Qualification 4772 : ICK_Identity; 4773 ICS.Standard.setFromType(T2); 4774 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4775 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4776 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4777 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4778 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = BindsDirectly; 4779 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4780 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4781 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue(); 4782 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4783 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = 4784 (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime) != 0; 4785 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4786 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4787 }; 4788 4789 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 4790 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 4791 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 4792 4793 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 4794 if (!isRValRef) { 4795 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 4796 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 4797 // 4798 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 4799 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) { 4800 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4801 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 4802 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 4803 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 4804 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 4805 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 4806 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 4807 SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/true); 4808 4809 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 4810 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 4811 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 4812 // [over.best.ics]p2). 4813 return ICS; 4814 } 4815 4816 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 4817 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 4818 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 4819 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 4820 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 4821 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 4822 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 4823 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 4824 S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4825 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 4826 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4827 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 4828 AllowExplicit)) 4829 return ICS; 4830 } 4831 } 4832 4833 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 4834 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 4835 // shall be an rvalue reference. 4836 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 4837 if (InitCategory.isRValue() && RefRelationship != Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 4838 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType); 4839 return ICS; 4840 } 4841 4842 // -- If the initializer expression 4843 // 4844 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function 4845 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or 4846 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible && 4847 (InitCategory.isXValue() || 4848 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && 4849 (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) || 4850 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) { 4851 // In C++11, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct 4852 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue. 4853 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we 4854 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of 4855 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here. 4856 SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 || 4857 !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType())); 4858 return ICS; 4859 } 4860 4861 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not 4862 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to 4863 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type 4864 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with 4865 // "cv3 T3", 4866 // 4867 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer 4868 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion 4869 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base 4870 // class subobject). 4871 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4872 T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4873 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4874 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 4875 AllowExplicit)) { 4876 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference 4877 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the 4878 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue 4879 // conversion, the program is ill-formed. 4880 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef && 4881 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) 4882 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4883 4884 return ICS; 4885 } 4886 4887 // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try. 4888 if (T1->isFunctionType()) 4889 return ICS; 4890 4891 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 4892 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 4893 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 4894 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 4895 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 4896 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 4897 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 4898 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 4899 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 4900 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 4901 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 4902 // initialization fails. 4903 // 4904 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here. 4905 // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important. 4906 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers(); 4907 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers(); 4908 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4909 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4910 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4911 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4912 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4913 T1Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4914 T2Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4915 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4916 return ICS; 4917 } 4918 4919 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 4920 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 4921 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 4922 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 4923 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 4924 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4925 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 4926 return ICS; 4927 4928 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue 4929 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue. 4930 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && isRValRef && 4931 Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) { 4932 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, Init, DeclType); 4933 return ICS; 4934 } 4935 4936 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 4937 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 4938 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 4939 // required to convert the argument expression to the 4940 // underlying type of the reference according to 4941 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 4942 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 4943 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 4944 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 4945 // and does not constitute a conversion. 4946 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4947 AllowedExplicit::None, 4948 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4949 /*CStyle=*/false, 4950 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 4951 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4952 4953 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 4954 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 4955 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4956 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4957 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4958 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true; 4959 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4960 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4961 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 4962 const ReferenceType *LValRefType = 4963 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType() 4964 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4965 4966 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3: 4967 // Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a 4968 // standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...] 4969 // binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function 4970 // lvalue. 4971 // Note that the function case is not possible here. 4972 if (isRValRef && LValRefType) { 4973 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4974 return ICS; 4975 } 4976 4977 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 4978 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4979 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4980 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType; 4981 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4982 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4983 } 4984 4985 return ICS; 4986 } 4987 4988 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4989 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4990 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4991 bool InOverloadResolution, 4992 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4993 bool AllowExplicit = false); 4994 4995 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the 4996 /// initializer list From. 4997 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4998 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType, 4999 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5000 bool InOverloadResolution, 5001 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 5002 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1: 5003 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and 5004 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type. 5005 5006 ImplicitConversionSequence Result; 5007 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 5008 5009 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be 5010 // initialized from init lists. 5011 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType)) 5012 return Result; 5013 5014 // Per DR1467: 5015 // If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single 5016 // element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the 5017 // implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element 5018 // to the parameter type. 5019 // 5020 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ] 5021 // and the initializer list has a single element that is an 5022 // appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the 5023 // implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion. 5024 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 5025 if (ToType->isRecordType()) { 5026 QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType(); 5027 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) || 5028 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), InitType, ToType)) 5029 return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 5030 SuppressUserConversions, 5031 InOverloadResolution, 5032 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5033 } 5034 5035 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)) { 5036 if (S.IsStringInit(From->getInit(0), AT)) { 5037 InitializedEntity Entity = 5038 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 5039 /*Consumed=*/false); 5040 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 5041 Result.setStandard(); 5042 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5043 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5044 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5045 return Result; 5046 } 5047 } 5048 } 5049 } 5050 5051 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below). 5052 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2: 5053 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and 5054 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit 5055 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an 5056 // element of the list to X. 5057 // 5058 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3: 5059 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer 5060 // list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is 5061 // default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list 5062 // can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is 5063 // the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X. 5064 // 5065 // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks. 5066 bool toStdInitializerList = false; 5067 QualType X; 5068 if (ToType->isArrayType()) 5069 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType(); 5070 else 5071 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X); 5072 if (!X.isNull()) { 5073 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) { 5074 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i); 5075 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5076 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions, 5077 InOverloadResolution, 5078 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5079 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail. 5080 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5081 Result = ICS; 5082 break; 5083 } 5084 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion. 5085 if (Result.isBad() || CompareImplicitConversionSequences( 5086 S, From->getBeginLoc(), ICS, Result) == 5087 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 5088 Result = ICS; 5089 } 5090 5091 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence. 5092 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence. 5093 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) { 5094 Result.setStandard(); 5095 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5096 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5097 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5098 } 5099 5100 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList); 5101 return Result; 5102 } 5103 5104 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4: 5105 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3: 5106 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload 5107 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit 5108 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple 5109 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the 5110 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 5111 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) { 5112 // This function can deal with initializer lists. 5113 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 5114 AllowedExplicit::None, 5115 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false, 5116 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5117 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5118 } 5119 5120 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5: 5121 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4: 5122 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be 5123 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion 5124 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 5125 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) { 5126 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes 5127 // down to checking whether the initialization works. 5128 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not. 5129 InitializedEntity Entity = 5130 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 5131 /*Consumed=*/false); 5132 if (S.CanPerformAggregateInitializationForOverloadResolution(Entity, 5133 From)) { 5134 Result.setUserDefined(); 5135 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5136 // Initializer lists don't have a type. 5137 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType()); 5138 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType()); 5139 5140 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5141 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType); 5142 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5143 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr; 5144 } 5145 return Result; 5146 } 5147 5148 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6: 5149 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5: 5150 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4. 5151 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) { 5152 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't 5153 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list- 5154 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that. 5155 5156 QualType T1 = ToType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 5157 5158 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related 5159 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that. 5160 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 5161 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0); 5162 5163 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 5164 5165 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 5166 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 5167 // type of the resulting function. 5168 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 5169 DeclAccessPair Found; 5170 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 5171 Init, ToType, false, Found)) 5172 T2 = Fn->getType(); 5173 } 5174 5175 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 5176 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship = 5177 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getBeginLoc(), T1, T2); 5178 5179 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) { 5180 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/ From->getBeginLoc(), 5181 SuppressUserConversions, 5182 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5183 } 5184 } 5185 5186 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the 5187 // initializer list. 5188 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 5189 InOverloadResolution, 5190 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5191 if (Result.isFailure()) 5192 return Result; 5193 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() && 5194 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion."); 5195 5196 // Can we even bind to a temporary? 5197 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() || 5198 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 5199 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard : 5200 Result.UserDefined.After; 5201 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true; 5202 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType(); 5203 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true; 5204 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5205 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 5206 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 5207 } else 5208 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, 5209 From, ToType); 5210 return Result; 5211 } 5212 5213 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7: 5214 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6: 5215 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class: 5216 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) { 5217 // - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an 5218 // initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one 5219 // required to convert the element to the parameter type. 5220 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits(); 5221 if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0))) 5222 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 5223 SuppressUserConversions, 5224 InOverloadResolution, 5225 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5226 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion 5227 // sequence is the identity conversion. 5228 else if (NumInits == 0) { 5229 Result.setStandard(); 5230 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5231 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5232 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5233 } 5234 return Result; 5235 } 5236 5237 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8: 5238 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7: 5239 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible 5240 return Result; 5241 } 5242 5243 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 5244 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 5245 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 5246 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 5247 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 5248 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 5249 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5250 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5251 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5252 bool InOverloadResolution, 5253 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5254 bool AllowExplicit) { 5255 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) 5256 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 5257 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5258 5259 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 5260 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 5261 /*FIXME:*/ From->getBeginLoc(), 5262 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit); 5263 5264 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 5265 SuppressUserConversions, 5266 AllowedExplicit::None, 5267 InOverloadResolution, 5268 /*CStyle=*/false, 5269 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5270 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5271 } 5272 5273 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy, 5274 const CanQualType ToQTy, 5275 Sema &S, 5276 SourceLocation Loc, 5277 ExprValueKind FromVK) { 5278 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK); 5279 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5280 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false); 5281 5282 return !ICS.isBad(); 5283 } 5284 5285 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 5286 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 5287 /// expression @p From. 5288 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5289 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType, 5290 Expr::Classification FromClassification, 5291 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 5292 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 5293 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 5294 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 5295 // const volatile object. 5296 Qualifiers Quals = Method->getMethodQualifiers(); 5297 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method)) { 5298 Quals.addConst(); 5299 Quals.addVolatile(); 5300 } 5301 5302 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 5303 5304 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 5305 // to exit early. 5306 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 5307 5308 // We need to have an object of class type. 5309 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5310 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5311 5312 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we 5313 // better have an lvalue. 5314 assert(FromClassification.isLValue()); 5315 } 5316 5317 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 5318 5319 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4: 5320 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object 5321 // parameter is 5322 // 5323 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a 5324 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier 5325 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the && 5326 // ref-qualifier 5327 // 5328 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the 5329 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration. 5330 // 5331 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we 5332 // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions 5333 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 5334 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 5335 // non-constant references. 5336 5337 // First check the qualifiers. 5338 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 5339 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 5340 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 5341 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 5342 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5343 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5344 return ICS; 5345 } 5346 5347 if (FromTypeCanon.hasAddressSpace()) { 5348 Qualifiers QualsImplicitParamType = ImplicitParamType.getQualifiers(); 5349 Qualifiers QualsFromType = FromTypeCanon.getQualifiers(); 5350 if (!QualsImplicitParamType.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(QualsFromType)) { 5351 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5352 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5353 return ICS; 5354 } 5355 } 5356 5357 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 5358 // affects the conversion rank. 5359 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 5360 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 5361 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 5362 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 5363 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType)) 5364 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 5365 else { 5366 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 5367 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5368 return ICS; 5369 } 5370 5371 // Check the ref-qualifier. 5372 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) { 5373 case RQ_None: 5374 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness. 5375 break; 5376 5377 case RQ_LValue: 5378 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && !Quals.hasOnlyConst()) { 5379 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue 5380 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType, 5381 ImplicitParamType); 5382 return ICS; 5383 } 5384 break; 5385 5386 case RQ_RValue: 5387 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) { 5388 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue 5389 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType, 5390 ImplicitParamType); 5391 return ICS; 5392 } 5393 break; 5394 } 5395 5396 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 5397 ICS.setStandard(); 5398 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5399 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 5400 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 5401 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 5402 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 5403 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 5404 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue; 5405 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5406 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue(); 5407 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier 5408 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None); 5409 return ICS; 5410 } 5411 5412 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 5413 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 5414 /// expression. 5415 ExprResult 5416 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, 5417 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 5418 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 5419 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 5420 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 5421 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 5422 Method->getThisType()->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5423 5424 Expr::Classification FromClassification; 5425 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5426 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5427 DestType = Method->getThisType(); 5428 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 5429 } else { 5430 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 5431 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 5432 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context); 5433 5434 // When performing member access on an rvalue, materialize a temporary. 5435 if (From->isRValue()) { 5436 From = CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(FromRecordType, From, 5437 Method->getRefQualifier() != 5438 RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue); 5439 } 5440 } 5441 5442 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 5443 // the actual argument initialization. 5444 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 5445 *this, From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method, 5446 Method->getParent()); 5447 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5448 switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) { 5449 case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: { 5450 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 5451 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 5452 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 5453 if (CVR) { 5454 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 5455 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 5456 << From->getSourceRange(); 5457 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5458 << Method->getDeclName(); 5459 return ExprError(); 5460 } 5461 break; 5462 } 5463 5464 case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue: 5465 case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: { 5466 bool IsRValueQualified = 5467 Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue; 5468 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref) 5469 << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue() 5470 << IsRValueQualified; 5471 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5472 << Method->getDeclName(); 5473 return ExprError(); 5474 } 5475 5476 case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion: 5477 case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class: 5478 break; 5479 } 5480 5481 return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type) 5482 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType 5483 << From->getSourceRange(); 5484 } 5485 5486 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 5487 ExprResult FromRes = 5488 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 5489 if (FromRes.isInvalid()) 5490 return ExprError(); 5491 From = FromRes.get(); 5492 } 5493 5494 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) { 5495 CastKind CK; 5496 QualType PteeTy = DestType->getPointeeType(); 5497 LangAS DestAS = 5498 PteeTy.isNull() ? DestType.getAddressSpace() : PteeTy.getAddressSpace(); 5499 if (FromRecordType.getAddressSpace() != DestAS) 5500 CK = CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 5501 else 5502 CK = CK_NoOp; 5503 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK, From->getValueKind()).get(); 5504 } 5505 return From; 5506 } 5507 5508 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 5509 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5510 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5511 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5512 // C++ [dcl.init]/17.8: 5513 // - Otherwise, if the initialization is direct-initialization, the source 5514 // type is std::nullptr_t, and the destination type is bool, the initial 5515 // value of the object being initialized is false. 5516 if (From->getType()->isNullPtrType()) 5517 return ImplicitConversionSequence::getNullptrToBool(From->getType(), 5518 S.Context.BoolTy, 5519 From->isGLValue()); 5520 5521 // All other direct-initialization of bool is equivalent to an implicit 5522 // conversion to bool in which explicit conversions are permitted. 5523 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 5524 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5525 AllowedExplicit::Conversions, 5526 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5527 /*CStyle=*/false, 5528 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5529 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5530 } 5531 5532 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 5533 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5534 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) { 5535 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5536 return ExprError(); 5537 5538 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 5539 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5540 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 5541 5542 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 5543 return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 5544 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 5545 return ExprError(); 5546 } 5547 5548 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant 5549 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion 5550 /// is acceptable. 5551 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S, 5552 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5553 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration 5554 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third 5555 // conversions are fine. 5556 switch (SCS.Second) { 5557 case ICK_Identity: 5558 case ICK_Integral_Promotion: 5559 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere. 5560 case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion: 5561 return true; 5562 5563 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 5564 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is 5565 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral 5566 // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression. 5567 // 5568 // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks 5569 // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this 5570 // (non-conforming) extension. 5571 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 5572 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType(); 5573 5574 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion: 5575 case ICK_Pointer_Member: 5576 // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are 5577 // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t. 5578 return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType(); 5579 5580 case ICK_Floating_Promotion: 5581 case ICK_Complex_Promotion: 5582 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 5583 case ICK_Complex_Conversion: 5584 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 5585 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion: 5586 case ICK_Derived_To_Base: 5587 case ICK_Vector_Conversion: 5588 case ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion: 5589 case ICK_Vector_Splat: 5590 case ICK_Complex_Real: 5591 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion: 5592 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion: 5593 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion: 5594 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion: 5595 case ICK_C_Only_Conversion: 5596 case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion: 5597 return false; 5598 5599 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue: 5600 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer: 5601 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer: 5602 llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second"); 5603 5604 case ICK_Function_Conversion: 5605 case ICK_Qualification: 5606 llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second"); 5607 5608 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds: 5609 break; 5610 } 5611 5612 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind"); 5613 } 5614 5615 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a 5616 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce 5617 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3. 5618 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From, 5619 QualType T, APValue &Value, 5620 Sema::CCEKind CCE, 5621 bool RequireInt, 5622 NamedDecl *Dest, 5623 bool *ValueDependent) { 5624 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 5625 "converted constant expression outside C++11"); 5626 5627 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From)) 5628 return ExprError(); 5629 5630 // C++1z [expr.const]p3: 5631 // A converted constant expression of type T is an expression, 5632 // implicitly converted to type T, where the converted 5633 // expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion 5634 // sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...]. 5635 // C++1z [stmt.if]p2: 5636 // If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the 5637 // condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type 5638 // bool. 5639 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5640 CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf || CCE == Sema::CCEK_ExplicitBool 5641 ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From) 5642 : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T, 5643 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5644 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5645 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5646 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5647 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr; 5648 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5649 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5650 SCS = &ICS.Standard; 5651 break; 5652 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5653 if (T->isRecordType()) 5654 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.Before; 5655 else 5656 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After; 5657 break; 5658 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5659 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5660 if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T)) 5661 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5662 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression) 5663 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5664 return ExprError(); 5665 5666 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5667 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression"); 5668 } 5669 5670 // Check that we would only use permitted conversions. 5671 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) { 5672 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5673 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 5674 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5675 } 5676 // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly. 5677 if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) { 5678 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5679 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect) 5680 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5681 } 5682 5683 // Usually we can simply apply the ImplicitConversionSequence we formed 5684 // earlier, but that's not guaranteed to work when initializing an object of 5685 // class type. 5686 ExprResult Result; 5687 if (T->isRecordType()) { 5688 assert(CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg && 5689 "unexpected class type converted constant expr"); 5690 Result = S.PerformCopyInitialization( 5691 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemplateParameter( 5692 T, cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Dest)), 5693 SourceLocation(), From); 5694 } else { 5695 Result = S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting); 5696 } 5697 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5698 return Result; 5699 5700 // C++2a [intro.execution]p5: 5701 // A full-expression is [...] a constant-expression [...] 5702 Result = 5703 S.ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.get(), From->getExprLoc(), 5704 /*DiscardedValue=*/false, /*IsConstexpr=*/true); 5705 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5706 return Result; 5707 5708 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 5709 bool ReturnPreNarrowingValue = false; 5710 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 5711 QualType PreNarrowingType; 5712 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue, 5713 PreNarrowingType)) { 5714 case NK_Dependent_Narrowing: 5715 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is 5716 // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing. 5717 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 5718 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 5719 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment. 5720 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 5721 break; 5722 5723 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 5724 if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_ArrayBound && 5725 PreNarrowingType->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 5726 PreNarrowingValue.isInt()) { 5727 // Don't diagnose array bound narrowing here; we produce more precise 5728 // errors by allowing the un-narrowed value through. 5729 ReturnPreNarrowingValue = true; 5730 break; 5731 } 5732 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5733 << CCE << /*Constant*/ 1 5734 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T; 5735 break; 5736 5737 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 5738 // FIXME: It would be better to diagnose that the expression is not a 5739 // constant expression. 5740 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5741 << CCE << /*Constant*/ 0 << From->getType() << T; 5742 break; 5743 } 5744 5745 if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) { 5746 Value = APValue(); 5747 if (ValueDependent) 5748 *ValueDependent = true; 5749 return Result; 5750 } 5751 5752 // Check the expression is a constant expression. 5753 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 5754 Expr::EvalResult Eval; 5755 Eval.Diag = &Notes; 5756 5757 ConstantExprKind Kind; 5758 if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg && T->isRecordType()) 5759 Kind = ConstantExprKind::ClassTemplateArgument; 5760 else if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg) 5761 Kind = ConstantExprKind::NonClassTemplateArgument; 5762 else 5763 Kind = ConstantExprKind::Normal; 5764 5765 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, S.Context, Kind) || 5766 (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) { 5767 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in 5768 // the AST. 5769 Result = ExprError(); 5770 } else { 5771 Value = Eval.Val; 5772 if (ValueDependent) 5773 *ValueDependent = Eval.Dependent; 5774 5775 if (Notes.empty()) { 5776 // It's a constant expression. 5777 Expr *E = Result.get(); 5778 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(E)) 5779 E = ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Result.get(), Value); 5780 if (ReturnPreNarrowingValue) 5781 Value = std::move(PreNarrowingValue); 5782 return E; 5783 } 5784 } 5785 5786 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic. 5787 if (Notes.size() == 1 && 5788 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 5789 S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE; 5790 } else if (!Notes.empty() && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 5791 diag::note_constexpr_invalid_template_arg) { 5792 Notes[0].second.setDiagID(diag::err_constexpr_invalid_template_arg); 5793 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5794 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5795 } else { 5796 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_cce) 5797 << CCE << From->getSourceRange(); 5798 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5799 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5800 } 5801 return ExprError(); 5802 } 5803 5804 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5805 APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE, 5806 NamedDecl *Dest, 5807 bool *ValueDependent) { 5808 return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false, 5809 Dest, ValueDependent); 5810 } 5811 5812 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5813 llvm::APSInt &Value, 5814 CCEKind CCE) { 5815 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type"); 5816 5817 APValue V; 5818 auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true, 5819 /*Dest=*/nullptr, 5820 /*ValueDependent=*/nullptr); 5821 if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent()) 5822 Value = V.getInt(); 5823 return R; 5824 } 5825 5826 5827 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence 5828 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change 5829 /// the result type of the conversion sequence. 5830 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5831 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 5832 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 5833 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 5834 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0]; 5835 } 5836 } 5837 5838 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually 5839 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5840 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5841 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5842 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'. 5843 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 5844 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 5845 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 5846 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 5847 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5848 AllowedExplicit::Conversions, 5849 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5850 /*CStyle=*/false, 5851 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5852 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true); 5853 5854 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'. 5855 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5856 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5857 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5858 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5859 break; 5860 5861 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5862 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After); 5863 break; 5864 5865 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5866 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard); 5867 break; 5868 } 5869 5870 return ICS; 5871 } 5872 5873 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual 5874 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5875 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists. 5876 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) { 5877 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5878 return ExprError(); 5879 5880 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5881 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5882 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From); 5883 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5884 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 5885 return ExprResult(); 5886 } 5887 5888 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration 5889 /// type of a permitted flavor. 5890 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) { 5891 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() 5892 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 5893 } 5894 5895 static ExprResult 5896 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5897 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5898 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) { 5899 5900 if (Converter.Suppress) 5901 return ExprError(); 5902 5903 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5904 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5905 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = 5906 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5907 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5908 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy); 5909 } 5910 return From; 5911 } 5912 5913 static bool 5914 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5915 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5916 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5917 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) { 5918 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) { 5919 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 5920 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5921 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5922 5923 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 5924 // conversion; use it. 5925 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5926 std::string TypeStr; 5927 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy()); 5928 5929 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy) 5930 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getBeginLoc(), 5931 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 5932 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 5933 SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getEndLoc()), ")"); 5934 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy); 5935 5936 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 5937 // explicit conversion function. 5938 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5939 return true; 5940 5941 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5942 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5943 HadMultipleCandidates); 5944 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5945 return true; 5946 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5947 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5948 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5949 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(), 5950 SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 5951 } 5952 return false; 5953 } 5954 5955 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5956 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5957 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5958 DeclAccessPair &Found) { 5959 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5960 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5961 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5962 5963 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5964 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) { 5965 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5966 return true; 5967 5968 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType) 5969 << From->getSourceRange(); 5970 } 5971 5972 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5973 HadMultipleCandidates); 5974 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5975 return true; 5976 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5977 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5978 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5979 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(), 5980 SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 5981 return false; 5982 } 5983 5984 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion( 5985 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5986 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5987 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress) 5988 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType()) 5989 << From->getSourceRange(); 5990 5991 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5992 } 5993 5994 static void 5995 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5996 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions, 5997 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 5998 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5999 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I]; 6000 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 6001 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 6002 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 6003 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 6004 6005 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 6006 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 6007 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 6008 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 6009 else 6010 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 6011 6012 if (ConvTemplate) 6013 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 6014 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet, 6015 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 6016 else 6017 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, 6018 ToType, CandidateSet, 6019 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, 6020 /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 6021 } 6022 } 6023 6024 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted 6025 /// by the given converter. 6026 /// 6027 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a 6028 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class 6029 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching 6030 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only 6031 /// one target type. 6032 /// 6033 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 6034 /// conversion. 6035 /// 6036 /// \param From The expression we're converting from. 6037 /// 6038 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process. 6039 /// 6040 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 6041 /// successful. 6042 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion( 6043 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 6044 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 6045 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 6046 return From; 6047 6048 // Process placeholders immediately. 6049 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) { 6050 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From); 6051 if (result.isInvalid()) 6052 return result; 6053 From = result.get(); 6054 } 6055 6056 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden. 6057 QualType T = From->getType(); 6058 if (Converter.match(T)) 6059 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 6060 6061 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 6062 6063 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class 6064 // type. 6065 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 6066 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6067 if (!Converter.Suppress) 6068 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 6069 return From; 6070 } 6071 6072 // We must have a complete class type. 6073 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser { 6074 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter; 6075 Expr *From; 6076 6077 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From) 6078 : Converter(Converter), From(From) {} 6079 6080 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 6081 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 6082 } 6083 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From); 6084 6085 if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T) 6086 : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser)) 6087 return From; 6088 6089 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 6090 UnresolvedSet<4> 6091 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y. 6092 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 6093 const auto &Conversions = 6094 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 6095 6096 bool HadMultipleCandidates = 6097 (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1); 6098 6099 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y: 6100 QualType ToType; 6101 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true; 6102 6103 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions. 6104 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 6105 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6106 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion; 6107 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6108 if (ConvTemplate) { 6109 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) 6110 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 6111 else 6112 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?). 6113 } else 6114 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 6115 6116 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) && 6117 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially " 6118 "viable in C++1y"); 6119 6120 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6121 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) { 6122 6123 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) { 6124 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction? 6125 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion() 6126 if (!ConvTemplate) 6127 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 6128 } else { 6129 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 6130 if (ToType.isNull()) 6131 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 6132 else if (HasUniqueTargetType && 6133 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType)) 6134 HasUniqueTargetType = false; 6135 } 6136 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 6137 } 6138 } 6139 } 6140 6141 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 6142 // C++1y [conv]p6: 6143 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context 6144 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified 6145 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly 6146 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched 6147 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to 6148 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be 6149 // exactly one such T. 6150 6151 // If no unique T is found: 6152 if (ToType.isNull()) { 6153 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6154 HadMultipleCandidates, 6155 ExplicitConversions)) 6156 return ExprError(); 6157 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 6158 } 6159 6160 // If more than one unique Ts are found: 6161 if (!HasUniqueTargetType) 6162 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6163 ViableConversions); 6164 6165 // If one unique T is found: 6166 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded 6167 // potentially viable conversions. 6168 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 6169 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions, 6170 CandidateSet); 6171 6172 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set. 6173 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 6174 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) { 6175 case OR_Success: { 6176 // Apply this conversion. 6177 DeclAccessPair Found = 6178 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess()); 6179 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6180 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 6181 return ExprError(); 6182 break; 6183 } 6184 case OR_Ambiguous: 6185 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6186 ViableConversions); 6187 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 6188 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6189 HadMultipleCandidates, 6190 ExplicitConversions)) 6191 return ExprError(); 6192 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 6193 case OR_Deleted: 6194 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 6195 break; 6196 } 6197 } else { 6198 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 6199 case 0: { 6200 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6201 HadMultipleCandidates, 6202 ExplicitConversions)) 6203 return ExprError(); 6204 6205 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 6206 break; 6207 } 6208 case 1: { 6209 // Apply this conversion. 6210 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 6211 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6212 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 6213 return ExprError(); 6214 break; 6215 } 6216 default: 6217 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6218 ViableConversions); 6219 } 6220 } 6221 6222 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 6223 } 6224 6225 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is 6226 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose 6227 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine 6228 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning 6229 /// enumeration types. 6230 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context, 6231 FunctionDecl *Fn, 6232 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 6233 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 6234 QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType(); 6235 6236 if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType())) 6237 return true; 6238 6239 if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType())) 6240 return true; 6241 6242 const auto *Proto = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 6243 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1) 6244 return false; 6245 6246 if (T1->isEnumeralType()) { 6247 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType(); 6248 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType)) 6249 return true; 6250 } 6251 6252 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2) 6253 return false; 6254 6255 if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) { 6256 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType(); 6257 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType)) 6258 return true; 6259 } 6260 6261 return false; 6262 } 6263 6264 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 6265 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 6266 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 6267 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 6268 /// 6269 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 6270 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 6271 /// code completion. 6272 void Sema::AddOverloadCandidate( 6273 FunctionDecl *Function, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6274 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 6275 bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowExplicitConversions, 6276 ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions, 6277 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6278 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6279 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6280 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6281 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 6282 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 6283 6284 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6285 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 6286 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 6287 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 6288 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 6289 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 6290 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 6291 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 6292 // is irrelevant. 6293 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(), 6294 Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args, 6295 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6296 PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions, PO); 6297 return; 6298 } 6299 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 6300 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 6301 } 6302 6303 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function, PO)) 6304 return; 6305 6306 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402] 6307 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by 6308 // overload resolution. 6309 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function); 6310 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() && 6311 Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) 6312 return; 6313 6314 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6315 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6316 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6317 6318 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 6319 // if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the 6320 // lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to 6321 // (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there 6322 // is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to 6323 // (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are 6324 // candidate functions. 6325 if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 6326 !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args)) 6327 return; 6328 6329 // Add this candidate 6330 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6331 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions); 6332 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6333 Candidate.Function = Function; 6334 Candidate.Viable = true; 6335 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6336 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Function, PO); 6337 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6338 Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate; 6339 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6340 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6341 6342 // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not 6343 // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point 6344 // to them in diagnostics. 6345 if (!AllowExplicit && ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Function).isExplicit()) { 6346 Candidate.Viable = false; 6347 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 6348 return; 6349 } 6350 6351 if (Function->isMultiVersion() && Function->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 6352 !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 6353 Candidate.Viable = false; 6354 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 6355 return; 6356 } 6357 6358 if (Constructor) { 6359 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 6360 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 6361 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 6362 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 6363 if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 6364 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 6365 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getBeginLoc(), Args[0]->getType(), 6366 ClassType))) { 6367 Candidate.Viable = false; 6368 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor; 6369 return; 6370 } 6371 6372 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution) 6373 // A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter 6374 // of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated 6375 // from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when 6376 // constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly 6377 // one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related 6378 // to C. 6379 auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl()); 6380 if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 && 6381 Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 6382 QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType(); 6383 QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent()); 6384 QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent()); 6385 SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc(); 6386 if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) && 6387 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) { 6388 Candidate.Viable = false; 6389 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice; 6390 return; 6391 } 6392 } 6393 6394 // Check that the constructor is capable of constructing an object in the 6395 // destination address space. 6396 if (!Qualifiers::isAddressSpaceSupersetOf( 6397 Constructor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace(), 6398 CandidateSet.getDestAS())) { 6399 Candidate.Viable = false; 6400 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch; 6401 } 6402 } 6403 6404 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6405 6406 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6407 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6408 // list (8.3.5). 6409 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6410 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6411 Candidate.Viable = false; 6412 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6413 return; 6414 } 6415 6416 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6417 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6418 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6419 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6420 // exactly m parameters. 6421 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6422 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6423 // Not enough arguments. 6424 Candidate.Viable = false; 6425 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6426 return; 6427 } 6428 6429 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6430 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6431 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6432 // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this 6433 // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is 6434 // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of 6435 // the class. 6436 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) { 6437 Candidate.Viable = false; 6438 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6439 return; 6440 } 6441 6442 if (Function->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 6443 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 6444 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Function, Satisfaction) || 6445 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 6446 Candidate.Viable = false; 6447 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 6448 return; 6449 } 6450 } 6451 6452 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6453 // arguments. 6454 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6455 unsigned ConvIdx = 6456 PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 - ArgIdx : ArgIdx; 6457 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 6458 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6459 // template argument deduction. 6460 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6461 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6462 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6463 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6464 // parameter of F. 6465 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6466 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization( 6467 *this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, SuppressUserConversions, 6468 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6469 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6470 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, AllowExplicitConversions); 6471 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6472 Candidate.Viable = false; 6473 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6474 return; 6475 } 6476 } else { 6477 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6478 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6479 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6480 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6481 } 6482 } 6483 6484 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 6485 CheckEnableIf(Function, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args)) { 6486 Candidate.Viable = false; 6487 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6488 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6489 return; 6490 } 6491 6492 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) { 6493 Candidate.Viable = false; 6494 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled; 6495 return; 6496 } 6497 } 6498 6499 ObjCMethodDecl * 6500 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance, 6501 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) { 6502 if (Methods.size() <= 1) 6503 return nullptr; 6504 6505 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6506 bool Match = true; 6507 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b]; 6508 unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs(); 6509 // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due 6510 // to addition of c-style arguments in method. 6511 if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs) 6512 NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size(); 6513 if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs) 6514 continue; 6515 6516 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) { 6517 // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument. 6518 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6519 Match = false; 6520 break; 6521 } 6522 6523 ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i]; 6524 Expr *argExpr = Args[i]; 6525 assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression"); 6526 6527 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's 6528 // a consumed argument. 6529 if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) && 6530 !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()) 6531 argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr); 6532 6533 // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method. 6534 if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 6535 Match = false; 6536 break; 6537 } 6538 6539 ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState 6540 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(), 6541 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false, 6542 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6543 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6544 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6545 /*AllowExplicit*/false); 6546 // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider 6547 // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here. 6548 if (ConversionState.isBad() || 6549 (ConversionState.isStandard() && 6550 ConversionState.Standard.Second == 6551 ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) { 6552 Match = false; 6553 break; 6554 } 6555 } 6556 // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods. 6557 if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) { 6558 for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) { 6559 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6560 Match = false; 6561 break; 6562 } 6563 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 6564 nullptr); 6565 if (Arg.isInvalid()) { 6566 Match = false; 6567 break; 6568 } 6569 } 6570 } else { 6571 // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods. 6572 if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs) 6573 Match = false; 6574 else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) { 6575 // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select 6576 // one with the most general result type of 'id'. 6577 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6578 QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType(); 6579 if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType()) 6580 return Methods[b]; 6581 } 6582 } 6583 } 6584 6585 if (Match) 6586 return Method; 6587 } 6588 return nullptr; 6589 } 6590 6591 static bool convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6592 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, SourceLocation CallLoc, 6593 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, bool MissingImplicitThis, 6594 Expr *&ConvertedThis, SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) { 6595 if (ThisArg) { 6596 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function); 6597 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6598 "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!"); 6599 assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!"); 6600 ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization( 6601 ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method); 6602 if (R.isInvalid()) 6603 return false; 6604 ConvertedThis = R.get(); 6605 } else { 6606 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6607 (void)MD; 6608 assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() || 6609 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) && 6610 "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods"); 6611 } 6612 ConvertedThis = nullptr; 6613 } 6614 6615 // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the 6616 // user can't refer to them in the function condition. 6617 unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size()); 6618 6619 // Convert the arguments. 6620 for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) { 6621 ExprResult R; 6622 R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 6623 S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)), 6624 SourceLocation(), Args[I]); 6625 6626 if (R.isInvalid()) 6627 return false; 6628 6629 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6630 } 6631 6632 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6633 return false; 6634 6635 // Push default arguments if needed. 6636 if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) { 6637 for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 6638 ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i); 6639 if (!P->hasDefaultArg()) 6640 return false; 6641 ExprResult R = S.BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, Function, P); 6642 if (R.isInvalid()) 6643 return false; 6644 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6645 } 6646 6647 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6648 return false; 6649 } 6650 return true; 6651 } 6652 6653 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, 6654 SourceLocation CallLoc, 6655 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6656 bool MissingImplicitThis) { 6657 auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 6658 if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end()) 6659 return nullptr; 6660 6661 SFINAETrap Trap(*this); 6662 SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs; 6663 // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed. 6664 Expr *DiscardedThis; 6665 if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6666 *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, CallLoc, Args, Trap, 6667 /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs)) 6668 return *EnableIfAttrs.begin(); 6669 6670 for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) { 6671 APValue Result; 6672 // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is 6673 // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully. 6674 if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent() || 6675 !EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6676 Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs))) 6677 return EIA; 6678 6679 if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) 6680 return EIA; 6681 } 6682 return nullptr; 6683 } 6684 6685 template <typename CheckFn> 6686 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND, 6687 bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc, 6688 CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) { 6689 SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs; 6690 for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) { 6691 if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent()) 6692 Attrs.push_back(DIA); 6693 } 6694 6695 // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early. 6696 if (Attrs.empty()) 6697 return false; 6698 6699 auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition( 6700 Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(), 6701 [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); }); 6702 6703 // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the 6704 // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes). 6705 auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin), 6706 IsSuccessful); 6707 if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) { 6708 const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr; 6709 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6710 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6711 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6712 return true; 6713 } 6714 6715 for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end())) 6716 if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) { 6717 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6718 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6719 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6720 } 6721 6722 return false; 6723 } 6724 6725 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function, 6726 const Expr *ThisArg, 6727 ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args, 6728 SourceLocation Loc) { 6729 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6730 *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc, 6731 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6732 APValue Result; 6733 // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since 6734 // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each 6735 // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to. 6736 if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6737 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg)) 6738 return false; 6739 return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue(); 6740 }); 6741 } 6742 6743 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND, 6744 SourceLocation Loc) { 6745 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6746 *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc, 6747 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6748 bool Result; 6749 return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) && 6750 Result; 6751 }); 6752 } 6753 6754 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 6755 /// the overload candidate set. 6756 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 6757 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6758 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6759 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6760 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6761 bool PartialOverloading, 6762 bool FirstArgumentIsBase) { 6763 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 6764 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6765 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 6766 6767 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6768 FunctionDecl *FD = 6769 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 6770 6771 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) { 6772 QualType ObjectType; 6773 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification; 6774 if (Args.size() > 0) { 6775 if (Expr *E = Args[0]) { 6776 // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup: 6777 ObjectType = E->getType(); 6778 // Pointers in the object arguments are implicitly dereferenced, so we 6779 // always classify them as l-values. 6780 if (!ObjectType.isNull() && ObjectType->isPointerType()) 6781 ObjectClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 6782 else 6783 ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context); 6784 } // .. else there is an implicit base. 6785 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6786 } 6787 if (FunTmpl) { 6788 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 6789 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6790 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 6791 ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6792 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6793 PartialOverloading); 6794 } else { 6795 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 6796 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType, 6797 ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6798 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6799 } 6800 } else { 6801 // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods. 6802 6803 // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access 6804 // static method as non-static. 6805 if (Args.size() > 0 && 6806 (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 6807 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) { 6808 assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()); 6809 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6810 } 6811 if (FunTmpl) { 6812 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6813 ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs, 6814 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6815 PartialOverloading); 6816 } else { 6817 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6818 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6819 } 6820 } 6821 } 6822 } 6823 6824 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 6825 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 6826 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType, 6827 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6828 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6829 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6830 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6831 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6832 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 6833 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 6834 6835 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 6836 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 6837 6838 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 6839 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 6840 "Expected a member function template"); 6841 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6842 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType, 6843 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6844 SuppressUserConversions, false, PO); 6845 } else { 6846 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6847 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6848 SuppressUserConversions, false, None, PO); 6849 } 6850 } 6851 6852 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 6853 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 6854 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 6855 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 6856 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 6857 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 6858 /// operators. 6859 void 6860 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6861 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 6862 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6863 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6864 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6865 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6866 bool PartialOverloading, 6867 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions, 6868 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6869 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6870 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6871 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6872 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6873 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 6874 6875 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method, PO)) 6876 return; 6877 6878 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402] 6879 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is 6880 // ignored by overload resolution. 6881 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() && 6882 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 6883 return; 6884 6885 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6886 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6887 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6888 6889 // Add this candidate 6890 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6891 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions); 6892 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6893 Candidate.Function = Method; 6894 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6895 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Method, PO); 6896 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6897 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6898 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6899 6900 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6901 6902 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6903 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6904 // list (8.3.5). 6905 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6906 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6907 Candidate.Viable = false; 6908 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6909 return; 6910 } 6911 6912 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6913 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6914 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6915 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6916 // exactly m parameters. 6917 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6918 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6919 // Not enough arguments. 6920 Candidate.Viable = false; 6921 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6922 return; 6923 } 6924 6925 Candidate.Viable = true; 6926 6927 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 6928 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 6929 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 6930 else { 6931 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0; 6932 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 6933 // parameter. 6934 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6935 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6936 Method, ActingContext); 6937 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6938 Candidate.Viable = false; 6939 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6940 return; 6941 } 6942 } 6943 6944 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6945 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6946 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6947 if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) { 6948 Candidate.Viable = false; 6949 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6950 return; 6951 } 6952 6953 if (Method->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 6954 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 6955 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Method, Satisfaction) || 6956 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 6957 Candidate.Viable = false; 6958 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 6959 return; 6960 } 6961 } 6962 6963 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6964 // arguments. 6965 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6966 unsigned ConvIdx = 6967 PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 0 : (ArgIdx + 1); 6968 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 6969 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6970 // template argument deduction. 6971 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6972 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6973 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6974 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6975 // parameter of F. 6976 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6977 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] 6978 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6979 SuppressUserConversions, 6980 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6981 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6982 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6983 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6984 Candidate.Viable = false; 6985 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6986 return; 6987 } 6988 } else { 6989 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6990 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6991 // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6992 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6993 } 6994 } 6995 6996 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 6997 CheckEnableIf(Method, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args, true)) { 6998 Candidate.Viable = false; 6999 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7000 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7001 return; 7002 } 7003 7004 if (Method->isMultiVersion() && Method->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 7005 !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 7006 Candidate.Viable = false; 7007 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 7008 } 7009 } 7010 7011 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 7012 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 7013 /// function template specialization. 7014 void Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 7015 FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7016 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 7017 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType, 7018 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7019 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7020 bool PartialOverloading, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7021 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl, PO)) 7022 return; 7023 7024 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 7025 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 7026 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 7027 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 7028 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 7029 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 7030 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 7031 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 7032 // functions. 7033 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7034 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7035 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 7036 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 7037 MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 7038 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 7039 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 7040 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 7041 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType, 7042 ObjectClassification, PO); 7043 })) { 7044 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 7045 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 7046 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7047 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 7048 Candidate.Viable = false; 7049 Candidate.RewriteKind = 7050 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO); 7051 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7052 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 7053 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() || 7054 ObjectType.isNull(); 7055 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7056 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 7057 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7058 else { 7059 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7060 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7061 Info); 7062 } 7063 return; 7064 } 7065 7066 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 7067 // deduction as a candidate. 7068 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 7069 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 7070 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 7071 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 7072 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, 7073 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading, 7074 Conversions, PO); 7075 } 7076 7077 /// Determine whether a given function template has a simple explicit specifier 7078 /// or a non-value-dependent explicit-specification that evaluates to true. 7079 static bool isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD) { 7080 return ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(FTD->getTemplatedDecl()).isExplicit(); 7081 } 7082 7083 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 7084 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 7085 /// an appropriate function template specialization. 7086 void Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 7087 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7088 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7089 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7090 bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, 7091 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7092 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate, PO)) 7093 return; 7094 7095 // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification, 7096 // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction 7097 // and substitution in this case. 7098 if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) { 7099 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7100 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7101 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7102 Candidate.Viable = false; 7103 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7104 return; 7105 } 7106 7107 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 7108 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 7109 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 7110 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 7111 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 7112 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 7113 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 7114 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 7115 // functions. 7116 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7117 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7118 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 7119 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 7120 FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 7121 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 7122 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 7123 FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 7124 SuppressUserConversions, nullptr, QualType(), {}, PO); 7125 })) { 7126 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 7127 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 7128 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7129 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7130 Candidate.Viable = false; 7131 Candidate.RewriteKind = 7132 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO); 7133 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7134 Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate; 7135 // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object 7136 // type. 7137 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 7138 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) && 7139 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function); 7140 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7141 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 7142 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7143 else { 7144 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7145 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7146 Info); 7147 } 7148 return; 7149 } 7150 7151 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 7152 // deduction as a candidate. 7153 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7154 AddOverloadCandidate( 7155 Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 7156 PartialOverloading, AllowExplicit, 7157 /*AllowExplicitConversions*/ false, IsADLCandidate, Conversions, PO); 7158 } 7159 7160 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument 7161 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's 7162 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10. 7163 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions( 7164 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes, 7165 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7166 ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7167 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 7168 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7169 // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor 7170 // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear 7171 // that is correct. 7172 const bool AllowExplicit = false; 7173 7174 auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7175 auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 7176 bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method); 7177 unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0; 7178 7179 Conversions = 7180 CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size()); 7181 7182 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7183 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7184 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7185 7186 // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't 7187 // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and 7188 // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations. 7189 if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() && 7190 !ObjectType.isNull()) { 7191 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0; 7192 Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7193 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 7194 Method, ActingContext); 7195 if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 7196 return true; 7197 } 7198 7199 for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N; 7200 ++I) { 7201 QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I]; 7202 if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) { 7203 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed 7204 ? 0 7205 : (ThisConversions + I); 7206 Conversions[ConvIdx] 7207 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType, 7208 SuppressUserConversions, 7209 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 7210 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7211 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 7212 AllowExplicit); 7213 if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 7214 return true; 7215 } 7216 } 7217 7218 return false; 7219 } 7220 7221 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result 7222 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++ 7223 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1. 7224 /// 7225 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function. 7226 /// 7227 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to. 7228 /// 7229 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one 7230 /// Objective-C pointer to another. 7231 /// 7232 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise. 7233 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S, 7234 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType, 7235 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) { 7236 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 7237 7238 // Easy case: the types are the same. 7239 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType)) 7240 return true; 7241 7242 // Allow qualification conversions. 7243 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 7244 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false, 7245 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 7246 return true; 7247 7248 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions, 7249 // we're done. 7250 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion) 7251 return false; 7252 7253 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion? 7254 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 7255 QualType ConvertedType; 7256 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType, 7257 IncompatibleObjC); 7258 } 7259 7260 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 7261 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 7262 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 7263 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 7264 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 7265 /// conversion function produces). 7266 void Sema::AddConversionCandidate( 7267 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7268 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7269 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7270 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) { 7271 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 7272 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 7273 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7274 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7275 return; 7276 7277 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its 7278 // deduction now. 7279 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) { 7280 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc())) 7281 return; 7282 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7283 } 7284 7285 // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion 7286 // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T. 7287 if (!AllowResultConversion && 7288 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType)) 7289 return; 7290 7291 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion 7292 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or 7293 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion. 7294 // 7295 // FIXME: Include such functions in the candidate list and explain why we 7296 // can't select them. 7297 if (Conversion->isExplicit() && 7298 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType, 7299 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) 7300 return; 7301 7302 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7303 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7304 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7305 7306 // Add this candidate 7307 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1); 7308 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7309 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 7310 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7311 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7312 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7313 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 7314 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 7315 Candidate.Viable = true; 7316 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7317 7318 // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not 7319 // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point 7320 // to them in diagnostics. 7321 if (!AllowExplicit && Conversion->isExplicit()) { 7322 Candidate.Viable = false; 7323 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7324 return; 7325 } 7326 7327 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 7328 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 7329 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 7330 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 7331 // 7332 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7333 // object parameter. 7334 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 7335 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 7336 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 7337 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 7338 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 7339 7340 Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7341 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(), 7342 From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext); 7343 7344 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 7345 Candidate.Viable = false; 7346 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7347 return; 7348 } 7349 7350 if (Conversion->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 7351 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 7352 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Conversion, Satisfaction) || 7353 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 7354 Candidate.Viable = false; 7355 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 7356 return; 7357 } 7358 } 7359 7360 // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a 7361 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 7362 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 7363 QualType FromCanon 7364 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 7365 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 7366 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || 7367 IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 7368 Candidate.Viable = false; 7369 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 7370 return; 7371 } 7372 7373 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 7374 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 7375 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 7376 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 7377 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 7378 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 7379 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 7380 // well-formed. 7381 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Context, Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(), 7382 VK_LValue, From->getBeginLoc()); 7383 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 7384 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 7385 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, &ConversionRef, 7386 VK_RValue, FPOptionsOverride()); 7387 7388 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType(); 7389 if (!isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ConversionType)) { 7390 Candidate.Viable = false; 7391 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7392 return; 7393 } 7394 7395 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType); 7396 7397 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 7398 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 7399 // allocator). 7400 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7401 7402 alignas(CallExpr) char Buffer[sizeof(CallExpr) + sizeof(Stmt *)]; 7403 CallExpr *TheTemporaryCall = CallExpr::CreateTemporary( 7404 Buffer, &ConversionFn, CallResultType, VK, From->getBeginLoc()); 7405 7406 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 7407 TryCopyInitialization(*this, TheTemporaryCall, ToType, 7408 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 7409 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7410 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 7411 7412 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 7413 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 7414 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 7415 7416 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 7417 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 7418 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 7419 // shall have exact match rank. 7420 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 7421 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 7422 Candidate.Viable = false; 7423 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 7424 return; 7425 } 7426 7427 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 7428 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and 7429 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined 7430 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the 7431 // program is ill-formed. 7432 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() && 7433 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) { 7434 Candidate.Viable = false; 7435 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7436 return; 7437 } 7438 break; 7439 7440 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 7441 Candidate.Viable = false; 7442 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7443 return; 7444 7445 default: 7446 llvm_unreachable( 7447 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 7448 } 7449 7450 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 7451 CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) { 7452 Candidate.Viable = false; 7453 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7454 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7455 return; 7456 } 7457 7458 if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() && Conversion->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 7459 !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 7460 Candidate.Viable = false; 7461 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 7462 } 7463 } 7464 7465 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization 7466 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 7467 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 7468 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 7469 /// [temp.deduct.conv]). 7470 void Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 7471 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7472 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7473 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7474 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) { 7475 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 7476 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 7477 7478 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 7479 return; 7480 7481 // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification, 7482 // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction 7483 // and substitution in this case. 7484 if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) { 7485 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7486 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7487 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7488 Candidate.Viable = false; 7489 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7490 return; 7491 } 7492 7493 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7494 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7495 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 7496 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 7497 Specialization, Info)) { 7498 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7499 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7500 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7501 Candidate.Viable = false; 7502 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7503 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7504 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7505 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7506 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7507 Info); 7508 return; 7509 } 7510 7511 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 7512 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 7513 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7514 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 7515 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7516 AllowExplicit, AllowResultConversion); 7517 } 7518 7519 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 7520 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 7521 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 7522 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 7523 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 7524 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 7525 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7526 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 7527 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 7528 Expr *Object, 7529 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7530 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 7531 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7532 return; 7533 7534 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7535 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7536 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7537 7538 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 7539 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7540 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7541 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 7542 Candidate.Viable = true; 7543 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 7544 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7545 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7546 7547 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7548 // object parameter. 7549 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7550 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(), 7551 Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext); 7552 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 7553 Candidate.Viable = false; 7554 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7555 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 7556 return; 7557 } 7558 7559 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 7560 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 7561 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 7562 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 7563 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 7564 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 7565 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false; 7566 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 7567 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl; 7568 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 7569 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 7570 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7571 7572 // Find the 7573 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 7574 7575 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 7576 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 7577 // list (8.3.5). 7578 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 7579 Candidate.Viable = false; 7580 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 7581 return; 7582 } 7583 7584 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 7585 // we have enough arguments. 7586 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 7587 // Not enough arguments. 7588 Candidate.Viable = false; 7589 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 7590 return; 7591 } 7592 7593 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7594 // arguments. 7595 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7596 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 7597 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 7598 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 7599 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 7600 // parameter of F. 7601 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 7602 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 7603 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 7604 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 7605 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7606 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7607 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7608 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 7609 Candidate.Viable = false; 7610 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7611 return; 7612 } 7613 } else { 7614 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 7615 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 7616 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 7617 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 7618 } 7619 } 7620 7621 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 7622 CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) { 7623 Candidate.Viable = false; 7624 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7625 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7626 return; 7627 } 7628 } 7629 7630 /// Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given 7631 /// function set to the overload candidate set. 7632 void Sema::AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates( 7633 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7634 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7635 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 7636 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 7637 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 7638 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 7639 7640 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 7641 FunctionDecl *FD = 7642 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 7643 7644 // Don't consider rewritten functions if we're not rewriting. 7645 if (!CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isAcceptableCandidate(FD)) 7646 continue; 7647 7648 assert(!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 7649 "unqualified operator lookup found a member function"); 7650 7651 if (FunTmpl) { 7652 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7653 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet); 7654 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) 7655 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 7656 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7657 {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, false, false, 7658 true, ADLCallKind::NotADL, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 7659 } else { 7660 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 7661 continue; 7662 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet); 7663 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) 7664 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), 7665 {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, 7666 false, false, true, false, ADLCallKind::NotADL, 7667 None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 7668 } 7669 } 7670 } 7671 7672 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 7673 /// member functions. 7674 /// 7675 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 7676 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 7677 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 7678 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 7679 /// [over.match.oper]). 7680 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 7681 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7682 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7683 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7684 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7685 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 7686 7687 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7688 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 7689 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 7690 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 7691 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 7692 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 7693 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 7694 // constructed as follows: 7695 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 7696 7697 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being 7698 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the 7699 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, 7700 // the set of member candidates is empty. 7701 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 7702 // Complete the type if it can be completed. 7703 if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined()) 7704 return; 7705 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now. 7706 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition()) 7707 return; 7708 7709 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 7710 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 7711 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 7712 7713 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 7714 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 7715 Oper != OperEnd; 7716 ++Oper) 7717 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 7718 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1), 7719 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false, PO); 7720 } 7721 } 7722 7723 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 7724 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 7725 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 7726 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 7727 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 7728 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 7729 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 7730 /// converted to bool. 7731 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7732 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 7733 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 7734 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7735 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7736 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7737 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7738 7739 // Add this candidate 7740 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 7741 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none); 7742 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7743 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7744 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7745 std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes); 7746 7747 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7748 // arguments. 7749 Candidate.Viable = true; 7750 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7751 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7752 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 7753 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 7754 // left operand are restricted as follows: 7755 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 7756 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 7757 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 7758 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 7759 // 7760 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 7761 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 7762 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 7763 // is not of the same type. 7764 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7765 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 7766 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 7767 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7768 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 7769 } else { 7770 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7771 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 7772 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 7773 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7774 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7775 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7776 } 7777 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 7778 Candidate.Viable = false; 7779 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7780 break; 7781 } 7782 } 7783 } 7784 7785 namespace { 7786 7787 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 7788 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 7789 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 7790 /// enumeration types. 7791 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 7792 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 7793 typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>, 7794 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet; 7795 7796 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 7797 /// built-in candidates. 7798 TypeSet PointerTypes; 7799 7800 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 7801 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7802 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 7803 7804 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 7805 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7806 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 7807 7808 /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 7809 /// candidates. 7810 TypeSet VectorTypes; 7811 7812 /// The set of matrix types that will be used in the built-in 7813 /// candidates. 7814 TypeSet MatrixTypes; 7815 7816 /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates 7817 bool HasNonRecordTypes; 7818 7819 /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types 7820 /// were present in the candidate set. 7821 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; 7822 7823 /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the 7824 /// candidate set. 7825 bool HasNullPtrType; 7826 7827 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 7828 /// candidate type set. 7829 Sema &SemaRef; 7830 7831 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 7832 ASTContext &Context; 7833 7834 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7835 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 7836 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 7837 7838 public: 7839 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 7840 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 7841 7842 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 7843 : HasNonRecordTypes(false), 7844 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false), 7845 HasNullPtrType(false), 7846 SemaRef(SemaRef), 7847 Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 7848 7849 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7850 SourceLocation Loc, 7851 bool AllowUserConversions, 7852 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7853 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 7854 7855 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> pointer_types() { return PointerTypes; } 7856 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> member_pointer_types() { 7857 return MemberPointerTypes; 7858 } 7859 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> enumeration_types() { 7860 return EnumerationTypes; 7861 } 7862 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> vector_types() { return VectorTypes; } 7863 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> matrix_types() { return MatrixTypes; } 7864 7865 bool containsMatrixType(QualType Ty) const { return MatrixTypes.count(Ty); } 7866 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; } 7867 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; } 7868 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; } 7869 }; 7870 7871 } // end anonymous namespace 7872 7873 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 7874 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7875 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7876 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7877 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7878 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7879 /// false otherwise. 7880 /// 7881 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7882 bool 7883 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7884 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7885 7886 // Insert this type. 7887 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7888 return false; 7889 7890 QualType PointeeTy; 7891 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 7892 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 7893 if (!PointerTy) { 7894 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7895 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 7896 buildObjCPtr = true; 7897 } else { 7898 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7899 } 7900 7901 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7902 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7903 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7904 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7905 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7906 return true; 7907 7908 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7909 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 7910 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 7911 7912 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 7913 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7914 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7915 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types. 7916 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 7917 7918 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if 7919 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified. 7920 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && 7921 (!hasRestrict || 7922 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType())))) 7923 continue; 7924 7925 // Build qualified pointee type. 7926 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7927 7928 // Build qualified pointer type. 7929 QualType QPointerTy; 7930 if (!buildObjCPtr) 7931 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7932 else 7933 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7934 7935 // Insert qualified pointer type. 7936 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy); 7937 } 7938 7939 return true; 7940 } 7941 7942 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 7943 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7944 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7945 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7946 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7947 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7948 /// false otherwise. 7949 /// 7950 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7951 bool 7952 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 7953 QualType Ty) { 7954 // Insert this type. 7955 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7956 return false; 7957 7958 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 7959 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 7960 7961 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7962 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7963 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7964 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7965 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7966 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7967 return true; 7968 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 7969 7970 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 7971 // qualifiers. 7972 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7973 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7974 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7975 7976 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7977 MemberPointerTypes.insert( 7978 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 7979 } 7980 7981 return true; 7982 } 7983 7984 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 7985 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 7986 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 7987 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 7988 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 7989 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 7990 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 7991 /// type. 7992 void 7993 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7994 SourceLocation Loc, 7995 bool AllowUserConversions, 7996 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7997 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7998 // Only deal with canonical types. 7999 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 8000 8001 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 8002 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 8003 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 8004 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 8005 8006 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 8007 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 8008 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 8009 8010 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type. 8011 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 8012 8013 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type. 8014 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 8015 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec; 8016 8017 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type. 8018 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = 8019 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType(); 8020 8021 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 8022 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 8023 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 8024 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 8025 // of types. 8026 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 8027 return; 8028 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 8029 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 8030 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 8031 return; 8032 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 8033 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 8034 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 8035 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 8036 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an 8037 // extension. 8038 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 8039 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 8040 } else if (Ty->isMatrixType()) { 8041 // Similar to vector types, we treat vector types as arithmetic types in 8042 // many contexts as an extension. 8043 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 8044 MatrixTypes.insert(Ty); 8045 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) { 8046 HasNullPtrType = true; 8047 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) { 8048 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 8049 if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty)) 8050 return; 8051 8052 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 8053 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 8054 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 8055 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 8056 8057 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 8058 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 8059 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 8060 continue; 8061 8062 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 8063 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 8064 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 8065 VisibleQuals); 8066 } 8067 } 8068 } 8069 } 8070 /// Helper function for adjusting address spaces for the pointer or reference 8071 /// operands of builtin operators depending on the argument. 8072 static QualType AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 8073 Expr *Arg) { 8074 return S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(T, Arg->getType().getAddressSpace()); 8075 } 8076 8077 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 8078 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 8079 /// given type to the candidate set. 8080 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 8081 QualType T, 8082 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8083 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 8084 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8085 8086 // T& operator=(T&, T) 8087 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8088 AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, T, Args[0])); 8089 ParamTypes[1] = T; 8090 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8091 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8092 8093 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 8094 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 8095 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8096 AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, S.Context.getVolatileType(T), 8097 Args[0])); 8098 ParamTypes[1] = T; 8099 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8100 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8101 } 8102 } 8103 8104 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 8105 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 8106 static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 8107 Qualifiers VRQuals; 8108 const RecordType *TyRec; 8109 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 8110 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 8111 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8112 else 8113 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8114 if (!TyRec) { 8115 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 8116 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 8117 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 8118 return VRQuals; 8119 } 8120 8121 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 8122 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 8123 return VRQuals; 8124 8125 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 8126 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 8127 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 8128 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 8129 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 8130 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 8131 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 8132 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 8133 // as see them. 8134 bool done = false; 8135 while (!done) { 8136 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 8137 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 8138 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 8139 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 8140 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 8141 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 8142 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 8143 else 8144 done = true; 8145 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 8146 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 8147 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 8148 return VRQuals; 8149 } 8150 } 8151 } 8152 return VRQuals; 8153 } 8154 8155 namespace { 8156 8157 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload 8158 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout 8159 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin 8160 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set. 8161 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder { 8162 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods. 8163 Sema &S; 8164 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args; 8165 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 8166 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType; 8167 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes; 8168 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet; 8169 8170 static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24; 8171 SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes; 8172 8173 // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithmetic types in 8174 // ArithmeticTypes. The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 8175 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 8176 unsigned FirstIntegralType, 8177 LastIntegralType; 8178 unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType, 8179 LastPromotedIntegralType; 8180 unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType, 8181 LastPromotedArithmeticType; 8182 unsigned NumArithmeticTypes; 8183 8184 void InitArithmeticTypes() { 8185 // Start of promoted types. 8186 FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0; 8187 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy); 8188 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy); 8189 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy); 8190 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type()) 8191 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty); 8192 8193 // Start of integral types. 8194 FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8195 FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8196 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy); 8197 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy); 8198 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy); 8199 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() || 8200 (S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo() && 8201 S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo()->hasInt128Type())) 8202 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty); 8203 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy); 8204 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy); 8205 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy); 8206 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() || 8207 (S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo() && 8208 S.Context.getAuxTargetInfo()->hasInt128Type())) 8209 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty); 8210 LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8211 LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8212 // End of promoted types. 8213 8214 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy); 8215 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy); 8216 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy); 8217 if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8) 8218 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty); 8219 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty); 8220 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty); 8221 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy); 8222 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy); 8223 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy); 8224 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy); 8225 LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8226 NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8227 // End of integral types. 8228 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half? 8229 8230 assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap && 8231 "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types."); 8232 } 8233 8234 /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads 8235 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators. 8236 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy, 8237 bool HasVolatile, 8238 bool HasRestrict) { 8239 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8240 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy), 8241 S.Context.IntTy 8242 }; 8243 8244 // Non-volatile version. 8245 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8246 8247 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set: 8248 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 8249 if (HasVolatile) { 8250 ParamTypes[0] = 8251 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8252 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy)); 8253 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8254 } 8255 8256 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type 8257 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer. 8258 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() && 8259 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) { 8260 ParamTypes[0] 8261 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8262 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict)); 8263 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8264 8265 if (HasVolatile) { 8266 ParamTypes[0] 8267 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8268 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, 8269 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8270 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8271 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8272 } 8273 } 8274 8275 } 8276 8277 /// Helper to add an overload candidate for a binary builtin with types \p L 8278 /// and \p R. 8279 void AddCandidate(QualType L, QualType R) { 8280 QualType LandR[2] = {L, R}; 8281 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8282 } 8283 8284 public: 8285 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder( 8286 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8287 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 8288 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 8289 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes, 8290 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) 8291 : S(S), Args(Args), 8292 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals), 8293 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType( 8294 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType), 8295 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes), 8296 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) { 8297 8298 InitArithmeticTypes(); 8299 } 8300 8301 // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17. 8302 // 8303 // C++ [over.built]p3: 8304 // 8305 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 8306 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 8307 // candidate operator functions of the form 8308 // 8309 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 8310 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 8311 // 8312 // C++ [over.built]p4: 8313 // 8314 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 8315 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 8316 // candidate operator functions of the form 8317 // 8318 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 8319 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 8320 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8321 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8322 return; 8323 8324 for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 8325 const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 8326 if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) { 8327 if (Op == OO_MinusMinus) 8328 continue; 8329 if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) 8330 continue; 8331 } 8332 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 8333 TypeOfT, 8334 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(), 8335 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()); 8336 } 8337 } 8338 8339 // C++ [over.built]p5: 8340 // 8341 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8342 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 8343 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8344 // 8345 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 8346 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 8347 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 8348 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 8349 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() { 8350 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) { 8351 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 8352 if (!PtrTy->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8353 continue; 8354 8355 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 8356 PtrTy, 8357 (!PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() && 8358 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()), 8359 (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() && 8360 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict())); 8361 } 8362 } 8363 8364 // C++ [over.built]p6: 8365 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 8366 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8367 // 8368 // T& operator*(T*); 8369 // 8370 // C++ [over.built]p7: 8371 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a 8372 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8373 // T& operator*(T*); 8374 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() { 8375 for (QualType ParamTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) { 8376 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 8377 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8378 continue; 8379 8380 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 8381 if (Proto->getMethodQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier()) 8382 continue; 8383 8384 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8385 } 8386 } 8387 8388 // C++ [over.built]p9: 8389 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 8390 // operator functions of the form 8391 // 8392 // T operator+(T); 8393 // T operator-(T); 8394 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() { 8395 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8396 return; 8397 8398 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8399 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 8400 QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 8401 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8402 } 8403 8404 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 8405 for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8406 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8407 } 8408 8409 // C++ [over.built]p8: 8410 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 8411 // the form 8412 // 8413 // T* operator+(T*); 8414 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() { 8415 for (QualType ParamTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) 8416 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8417 } 8418 8419 // C++ [over.built]p10: 8420 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 8421 // operator functions of the form 8422 // 8423 // T operator~(T); 8424 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() { 8425 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8426 return; 8427 8428 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8429 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 8430 QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int]; 8431 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8432 } 8433 8434 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 8435 for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8436 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8437 } 8438 8439 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 8440 // For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there 8441 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8442 // 8443 // bool operator==(T,T); 8444 // bool operator!=(T,T); 8445 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() { 8446 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8447 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8448 8449 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8450 for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) { 8451 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8452 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second) 8453 continue; 8454 8455 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {MemPtrTy, MemPtrTy}; 8456 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8457 } 8458 8459 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) { 8460 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy); 8461 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) { 8462 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy }; 8463 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8464 } 8465 } 8466 } 8467 } 8468 8469 // C++ [over.built]p15: 8470 // 8471 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type, 8472 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8473 // 8474 // bool operator<(T, T); 8475 // bool operator>(T, T); 8476 // bool operator<=(T, T); 8477 // bool operator>=(T, T); 8478 // bool operator==(T, T); 8479 // bool operator!=(T, T); 8480 // R operator<=>(T, T) 8481 void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8482 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8483 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator 8484 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...] 8485 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member 8486 // candidate. 8487 // 8488 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there 8489 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator 8490 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other 8491 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=, 8492 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place 8493 // where we must suppress candidates like this. 8494 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 8495 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 8496 8497 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8498 if (!CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types().empty()) { 8499 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 8500 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 8501 C != CEnd; ++C) { 8502 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 8503 continue; 8504 8505 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 8506 continue; 8507 8508 // We interpret "same parameter-type-list" as applying to the 8509 // "synthesized candidate, with the order of the two parameters 8510 // reversed", not to the original function. 8511 bool Reversed = C->isReversed(); 8512 QualType FirstParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 1 : 0) 8513 ->getType() 8514 .getUnqualifiedType(); 8515 QualType SecondParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 0 : 1) 8516 ->getType() 8517 .getUnqualifiedType(); 8518 8519 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type. 8520 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() || 8521 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 8522 continue; 8523 8524 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 8525 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 8526 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 8527 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 8528 } 8529 } 8530 } 8531 8532 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8533 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8534 8535 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8536 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_types()) { 8537 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8538 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second) 8539 continue; 8540 8541 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy}; 8542 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8543 } 8544 for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) { 8545 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy); 8546 8547 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined 8548 // candidate exists. 8549 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second || 8550 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType, 8551 CanonType))) 8552 continue; 8553 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {EnumTy, EnumTy}; 8554 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8555 } 8556 } 8557 } 8558 8559 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8560 // 8561 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 8562 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8563 // 8564 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8565 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 8566 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8567 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8568 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 8569 // 8570 // C++ [over.built]p14: 8571 // 8572 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 8573 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8574 // 8575 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8576 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8577 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8578 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8579 8580 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) { 8581 QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = { 8582 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8583 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8584 }; 8585 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_types()) { 8586 QualType PointeeTy = PtrTy->getPointeeType(); 8587 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType()) 8588 continue; 8589 8590 AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = PtrTy; 8591 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) { 8592 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 8593 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8594 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8595 } 8596 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 8597 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8598 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second) 8599 continue; 8600 8601 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy}; 8602 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8603 } 8604 } 8605 } 8606 } 8607 8608 // C++ [over.built]p12: 8609 // 8610 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 8611 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8612 // 8613 // LR operator*(L, R); 8614 // LR operator/(L, R); 8615 // LR operator+(L, R); 8616 // LR operator-(L, R); 8617 // bool operator<(L, R); 8618 // bool operator>(L, R); 8619 // bool operator<=(L, R); 8620 // bool operator>=(L, R); 8621 // bool operator==(L, R); 8622 // bool operator!=(L, R); 8623 // 8624 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8625 // between types L and R. 8626 // 8627 // C++ [over.built]p24: 8628 // 8629 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 8630 // candidate operator functions of the form 8631 // 8632 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 8633 // 8634 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8635 // between types L and R. 8636 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 8637 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8638 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8639 return; 8640 8641 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8642 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 8643 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8644 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8645 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8646 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8647 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8648 } 8649 } 8650 8651 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 8652 // conditional operator for vector types. 8653 for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8654 for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[1].vector_types()) { 8655 QualType LandR[2] = {Vec1Ty, Vec2Ty}; 8656 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8657 } 8658 } 8659 8660 /// Add binary operator overloads for each candidate matrix type M1, M2: 8661 /// * (M1, M1) -> M1 8662 /// * (M1, M1.getElementType()) -> M1 8663 /// * (M2.getElementType(), M2) -> M2 8664 /// * (M2, M2) -> M2 // Only if M2 is not part of CandidateTypes[0]. 8665 void addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8666 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8667 return; 8668 8669 for (QualType M1 : CandidateTypes[0].matrix_types()) { 8670 AddCandidate(M1, cast<MatrixType>(M1)->getElementType()); 8671 AddCandidate(M1, M1); 8672 } 8673 8674 for (QualType M2 : CandidateTypes[1].matrix_types()) { 8675 AddCandidate(cast<MatrixType>(M2)->getElementType(), M2); 8676 if (!CandidateTypes[0].containsMatrixType(M2)) 8677 AddCandidate(M2, M2); 8678 } 8679 } 8680 8681 // C++2a [over.built]p14: 8682 // 8683 // For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function 8684 // of the form 8685 // 8686 // std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T) 8687 // 8688 // C++2a [over.built]p15: 8689 // 8690 // For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate 8691 // operator function of the form 8692 // 8693 // std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R); 8694 // 8695 // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with 8696 // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum 8697 // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during 8698 // overload resolution. For example: 8699 // 8700 // enum A : int {a}; 8701 // auto x = (a <=> (long)42); 8702 // 8703 // error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'. 8704 // note: candidate operator<=>(int, int) 8705 // note: candidate operator<=>(long, long) 8706 // 8707 // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds 8708 // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted 8709 // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads). 8710 // 8711 // For now this function acts as a placeholder. 8712 void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() { 8713 addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8714 } 8715 8716 // C++ [over.built]p17: 8717 // 8718 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 8719 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8720 // 8721 // LR operator%(L, R); 8722 // LR operator&(L, R); 8723 // LR operator^(L, R); 8724 // LR operator|(L, R); 8725 // L operator<<(L, R); 8726 // L operator>>(L, R); 8727 // 8728 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8729 // between types L and R. 8730 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8731 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8732 return; 8733 8734 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8735 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 8736 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8737 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8738 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8739 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8740 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8741 } 8742 } 8743 } 8744 8745 // C++ [over.built]p20: 8746 // 8747 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 8748 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 8749 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8750 // 8751 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 8752 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8753 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8754 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8755 8756 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8757 for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) { 8758 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy)).second) 8759 continue; 8760 8761 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, EnumTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8762 } 8763 8764 for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) { 8765 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second) 8766 continue; 8767 8768 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, MemPtrTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8769 } 8770 } 8771 } 8772 8773 // C++ [over.built]p19: 8774 // 8775 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 8776 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 8777 // of the form 8778 // 8779 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 8780 // 8781 // C++ [over.built]p21: 8782 // 8783 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8784 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 8785 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8786 // 8787 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8788 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8789 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8790 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8791 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8792 8793 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) { 8794 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 8795 if (isEqualOp) 8796 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)); 8797 else if (!PtrTy->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8798 continue; 8799 8800 // non-volatile version 8801 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8802 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PtrTy), 8803 isEqualOp ? PtrTy : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8804 }; 8805 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8806 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp); 8807 8808 bool NeedVolatile = !PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() && 8809 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8810 if (NeedVolatile) { 8811 // volatile version 8812 ParamTypes[0] = 8813 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(PtrTy)); 8814 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8815 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8816 } 8817 8818 if (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() && 8819 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8820 // restrict version 8821 ParamTypes[0] = 8822 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(PtrTy)); 8823 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8824 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8825 8826 if (NeedVolatile) { 8827 // volatile restrict version 8828 ParamTypes[0] = 8829 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType( 8830 PtrTy, (Qualifiers::Volatile | Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8831 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8832 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8833 } 8834 } 8835 } 8836 8837 if (isEqualOp) { 8838 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].pointer_types()) { 8839 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 8840 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second) 8841 continue; 8842 8843 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8844 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PtrTy), 8845 PtrTy, 8846 }; 8847 8848 // non-volatile version 8849 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8850 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8851 8852 bool NeedVolatile = !PtrTy.isVolatileQualified() && 8853 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8854 if (NeedVolatile) { 8855 // volatile version 8856 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8857 S.Context.getVolatileType(PtrTy)); 8858 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8859 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8860 } 8861 8862 if (!PtrTy.isRestrictQualified() && 8863 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8864 // restrict version 8865 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8866 S.Context.getRestrictType(PtrTy)); 8867 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8868 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8869 8870 if (NeedVolatile) { 8871 // volatile restrict version 8872 ParamTypes[0] = 8873 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType( 8874 PtrTy, (Qualifiers::Volatile | Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8875 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8876 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8877 } 8878 } 8879 } 8880 } 8881 } 8882 8883 // C++ [over.built]p18: 8884 // 8885 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 8886 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 8887 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 8888 // the form 8889 // 8890 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 8891 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 8892 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 8893 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 8894 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 8895 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8896 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8897 return; 8898 8899 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 8900 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8901 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8902 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8903 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8904 auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType( 8905 S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]); 8906 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8907 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy); 8908 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8909 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8910 8911 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8912 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8913 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(LeftBaseTy); 8914 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8915 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8916 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8917 } 8918 } 8919 } 8920 8921 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 8922 for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8923 for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) { 8924 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8925 ParamTypes[1] = Vec2Ty; 8926 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8927 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(Vec1Ty); 8928 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8929 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8930 8931 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8932 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8933 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(Vec1Ty); 8934 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8935 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8936 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8937 } 8938 } 8939 } 8940 8941 // C++ [over.built]p22: 8942 // 8943 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 8944 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 8945 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8946 // 8947 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 8948 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 8949 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 8950 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 8951 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 8952 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 8953 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() { 8954 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8955 return; 8956 8957 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 8958 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8959 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8960 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8961 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8962 auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType( 8963 S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]); 8964 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8965 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy); 8966 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8967 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8968 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8969 ParamTypes[0] = LeftBaseTy; 8970 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 8971 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8972 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8973 } 8974 } 8975 } 8976 } 8977 8978 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 8979 // 8980 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 8981 // 8982 // bool operator!(bool); 8983 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 8984 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 8985 void addExclaimOverload() { 8986 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy; 8987 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet, 8988 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8989 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 8990 } 8991 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() { 8992 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy }; 8993 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8994 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8995 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 8996 } 8997 8998 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8999 // 9000 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 9001 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 9002 // 9003 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 9004 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 9005 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 9006 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 9007 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 9008 void addSubscriptOverloads() { 9009 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) { 9010 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, S.Context.getPointerDiffType()}; 9011 QualType PointeeType = PtrTy->getPointeeType(); 9012 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 9013 continue; 9014 9015 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 9016 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9017 } 9018 9019 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].pointer_types()) { 9020 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), PtrTy}; 9021 QualType PointeeType = PtrTy->getPointeeType(); 9022 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 9023 continue; 9024 9025 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 9026 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9027 } 9028 } 9029 9030 // C++ [over.built]p11: 9031 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 9032 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 9033 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 9034 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 9035 // 9036 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 9037 // 9038 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 9039 void addArrowStarOverloads() { 9040 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[0].pointer_types()) { 9041 QualType C1Ty = PtrTy; 9042 QualType C1; 9043 QualifierCollector Q1; 9044 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 9045 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 9046 continue; 9047 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 9048 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 9049 // volatile/restrict type. 9050 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 9051 continue; 9052 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 9053 continue; 9054 for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_types()) { 9055 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(MemPtrTy); 9056 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 9057 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 9058 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2)) 9059 break; 9060 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, MemPtrTy}; 9061 // build CV12 T& 9062 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 9063 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 9064 T.isVolatileQualified()) 9065 continue; 9066 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 9067 T.isRestrictQualified()) 9068 continue; 9069 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T); 9070 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9071 } 9072 } 9073 } 9074 9075 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 9076 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 9077 // therefore added as binary. 9078 // 9079 // C++ [over.built]p25: 9080 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 9081 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 9082 // 9083 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 9084 // 9085 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() { 9086 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 9087 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 9088 9089 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 9090 for (QualType PtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_types()) { 9091 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(PtrTy)).second) 9092 continue; 9093 9094 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {PtrTy, PtrTy}; 9095 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9096 } 9097 9098 for (QualType MemPtrTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_types()) { 9099 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(MemPtrTy)).second) 9100 continue; 9101 9102 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {MemPtrTy, MemPtrTy}; 9103 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9104 } 9105 9106 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 9107 for (QualType EnumTy : CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_types()) { 9108 if (!EnumTy->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 9109 continue; 9110 9111 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(EnumTy)).second) 9112 continue; 9113 9114 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {EnumTy, EnumTy}; 9115 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9116 } 9117 } 9118 } 9119 } 9120 }; 9121 9122 } // end anonymous namespace 9123 9124 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 9125 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 9126 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 9127 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 9128 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 9129 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 9130 SourceLocation OpLoc, 9131 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9132 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 9133 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 9134 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 9135 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record 9136 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types. 9137 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 9138 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 9139 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) 9140 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 9141 9142 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false; 9143 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false; 9144 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 9145 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 9146 CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this); 9147 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 9148 OpLoc, 9149 true, 9150 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 9151 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 9152 Op == OO_PipePipe), 9153 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 9154 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType || 9155 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes(); 9156 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = 9157 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType || 9158 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(); 9159 } 9160 9161 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set 9162 // for any of the arguments to the operator. 9163 // 9164 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have 9165 // 'bool' overloads. 9166 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType && 9167 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe)) 9168 return; 9169 9170 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads. 9171 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, 9172 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 9173 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 9174 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet); 9175 9176 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply. 9177 switch (Op) { 9178 case OO_None: 9179 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 9180 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator"); 9181 9182 case OO_New: 9183 case OO_Delete: 9184 case OO_Array_New: 9185 case OO_Array_Delete: 9186 case OO_Call: 9187 llvm_unreachable( 9188 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 9189 9190 case OO_Comma: 9191 case OO_Arrow: 9192 case OO_Coawait: 9193 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 9194 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the 9195 // operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the 9196 // built-in candidates set is empty. 9197 break; 9198 9199 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 9200 if (Args.size() == 1) 9201 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads(); 9202 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9203 9204 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 9205 if (Args.size() == 1) { 9206 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads(); 9207 } else { 9208 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op); 9209 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9210 OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9211 } 9212 break; 9213 9214 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 9215 if (Args.size() == 1) 9216 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads(); 9217 else { 9218 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9219 OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9220 } 9221 break; 9222 9223 case OO_Slash: 9224 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9225 break; 9226 9227 case OO_PlusPlus: 9228 case OO_MinusMinus: 9229 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9230 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads(); 9231 break; 9232 9233 case OO_EqualEqual: 9234 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 9235 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads(); 9236 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9237 9238 case OO_Less: 9239 case OO_Greater: 9240 case OO_LessEqual: 9241 case OO_GreaterEqual: 9242 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9243 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9244 break; 9245 9246 case OO_Spaceship: 9247 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9248 OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads(); 9249 break; 9250 9251 case OO_Percent: 9252 case OO_Caret: 9253 case OO_Pipe: 9254 case OO_LessLess: 9255 case OO_GreaterGreater: 9256 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9257 break; 9258 9259 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 9260 if (Args.size() == 1) 9261 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 9262 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 9263 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 9264 break; 9265 9266 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9267 break; 9268 9269 case OO_Tilde: 9270 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads(); 9271 break; 9272 9273 case OO_Equal: 9274 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9275 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9276 9277 case OO_PlusEqual: 9278 case OO_MinusEqual: 9279 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 9280 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9281 9282 case OO_StarEqual: 9283 case OO_SlashEqual: 9284 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 9285 break; 9286 9287 case OO_PercentEqual: 9288 case OO_LessLessEqual: 9289 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 9290 case OO_AmpEqual: 9291 case OO_CaretEqual: 9292 case OO_PipeEqual: 9293 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads(); 9294 break; 9295 9296 case OO_Exclaim: 9297 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload(); 9298 break; 9299 9300 case OO_AmpAmp: 9301 case OO_PipePipe: 9302 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload(); 9303 break; 9304 9305 case OO_Subscript: 9306 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads(); 9307 break; 9308 9309 case OO_ArrowStar: 9310 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads(); 9311 break; 9312 9313 case OO_Conditional: 9314 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads(); 9315 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9316 break; 9317 } 9318 } 9319 9320 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 9321 /// to the set of overloading candidates. 9322 /// 9323 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 9324 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 9325 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 9326 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 9327 void 9328 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 9329 SourceLocation Loc, 9330 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9331 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 9332 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 9333 bool PartialOverloading) { 9334 ADLResult Fns; 9335 9336 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 9337 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 9338 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 9339 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 9340 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 9341 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 9342 9343 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 9344 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns); 9345 9346 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 9347 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 9348 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 9349 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 9350 if (Cand->Function) { 9351 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 9352 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 9353 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 9354 } 9355 9356 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 9357 // set. 9358 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 9359 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 9360 9361 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 9362 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 9363 continue; 9364 9365 AddOverloadCandidate( 9366 FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 9367 PartialOverloading, /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 9368 /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, ADLCallKind::UsesADL); 9369 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) { 9370 AddOverloadCandidate( 9371 FD, FoundDecl, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet, 9372 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9373 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, 9374 ADLCallKind::UsesADL, None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 9375 } 9376 } else { 9377 auto *FTD = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I); 9378 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 9379 FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 9380 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9381 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL); 9382 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed( 9383 Context, FTD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 9384 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 9385 FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, {Args[1], Args[0]}, 9386 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9387 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL, 9388 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 9389 } 9390 } 9391 } 9392 } 9393 9394 namespace { 9395 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse }; 9396 } 9397 9398 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of 9399 /// overload resolution. 9400 /// 9401 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff 9402 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as 9403 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if 9404 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes. 9405 /// 9406 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if 9407 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are 9408 /// worse than Cand1's. 9409 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1, 9410 const FunctionDecl *Cand2) { 9411 // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs. 9412 bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 9413 bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 9414 if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) { 9415 if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr) 9416 return Comparison::Equal; 9417 return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse; 9418 } 9419 9420 auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 9421 auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 9422 9423 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID; 9424 for (auto Pair : zip_longest(Cand1Attrs, Cand2Attrs)) { 9425 Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand1A = std::get<0>(Pair); 9426 Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand2A = std::get<1>(Pair); 9427 9428 // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1 9429 // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2, and vice versa. 9430 if (!Cand1A) 9431 return Comparison::Worse; 9432 if (!Cand2A) 9433 return Comparison::Better; 9434 9435 Cand1ID.clear(); 9436 Cand2ID.clear(); 9437 9438 (*Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 9439 (*Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 9440 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID) 9441 return Comparison::Worse; 9442 } 9443 9444 return Comparison::Equal; 9445 } 9446 9447 static Comparison 9448 isBetterMultiversionCandidate(const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, 9449 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2) { 9450 if (!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->isMultiVersion() || !Cand2.Function || 9451 !Cand2.Function->isMultiVersion()) 9452 return Comparison::Equal; 9453 9454 // If both are invalid, they are equal. If one of them is invalid, the other 9455 // is better. 9456 if (Cand1.Function->isInvalidDecl()) { 9457 if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 9458 return Comparison::Equal; 9459 return Comparison::Worse; 9460 } 9461 if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 9462 return Comparison::Better; 9463 9464 // If this is a cpu_dispatch/cpu_specific multiversion situation, prefer 9465 // cpu_dispatch, else arbitrarily based on the identifiers. 9466 bool Cand1CPUDisp = Cand1.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 9467 bool Cand2CPUDisp = Cand2.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 9468 const auto *Cand1CPUSpec = Cand1.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 9469 const auto *Cand2CPUSpec = Cand2.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 9470 9471 if (!Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUSpec && !Cand2CPUSpec) 9472 return Comparison::Equal; 9473 9474 if (Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp) 9475 return Comparison::Better; 9476 if (Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUDisp) 9477 return Comparison::Worse; 9478 9479 if (Cand1CPUSpec && Cand2CPUSpec) { 9480 if (Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() != Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size()) 9481 return Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() < Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size() 9482 ? Comparison::Better 9483 : Comparison::Worse; 9484 9485 std::pair<CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator, CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator> 9486 FirstDiff = std::mismatch( 9487 Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end(), 9488 Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 9489 [](const IdentifierInfo *LHS, const IdentifierInfo *RHS) { 9490 return LHS->getName() == RHS->getName(); 9491 }); 9492 9493 assert(FirstDiff.first != Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end() && 9494 "Two different cpu-specific versions should not have the same " 9495 "identifier list, otherwise they'd be the same decl!"); 9496 return (*FirstDiff.first)->getName() < (*FirstDiff.second)->getName() 9497 ? Comparison::Better 9498 : Comparison::Worse; 9499 } 9500 llvm_unreachable("No way to get here unless both had cpu_dispatch"); 9501 } 9502 9503 /// Compute the type of the implicit object parameter for the given function, 9504 /// if any. Returns None if there is no implicit object parameter, and a null 9505 /// QualType if there is a 'matches anything' implicit object parameter. 9506 static Optional<QualType> getImplicitObjectParamType(ASTContext &Context, 9507 const FunctionDecl *F) { 9508 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(F) || isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(F)) 9509 return llvm::None; 9510 9511 auto *M = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(F); 9512 // Static member functions' object parameters match all types. 9513 if (M->isStatic()) 9514 return QualType(); 9515 9516 QualType T = M->getThisObjectType(); 9517 if (M->getRefQualifier() == RQ_RValue) 9518 return Context.getRValueReferenceType(T); 9519 return Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 9520 } 9521 9522 static bool haveSameParameterTypes(ASTContext &Context, const FunctionDecl *F1, 9523 const FunctionDecl *F2, unsigned NumParams) { 9524 if (declaresSameEntity(F1, F2)) 9525 return true; 9526 9527 auto NextParam = [&](const FunctionDecl *F, unsigned &I, bool First) { 9528 if (First) { 9529 if (Optional<QualType> T = getImplicitObjectParamType(Context, F)) 9530 return *T; 9531 } 9532 assert(I < F->getNumParams()); 9533 return F->getParamDecl(I++)->getType(); 9534 }; 9535 9536 unsigned I1 = 0, I2 = 0; 9537 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumParams; ++I) { 9538 QualType T1 = NextParam(F1, I1, I == 0); 9539 QualType T2 = NextParam(F2, I2, I == 0); 9540 if (!T1.isNull() && !T1.isNull() && !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 9541 return false; 9542 } 9543 return true; 9544 } 9545 9546 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 9547 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 9548 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate( 9549 Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 9550 SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) { 9551 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 9552 // functions. 9553 if (!Cand2.Viable) 9554 return Cand1.Viable; 9555 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 9556 return false; 9557 9558 // [CUDA] A function with 'never' preference is marked not viable, therefore 9559 // is never shown up here. The worst preference shown up here is 'wrong side', 9560 // e.g. an H function called by a HD function in device compilation. This is 9561 // valid AST as long as the HD function is not emitted, e.g. it is an inline 9562 // function which is called only by an H function. A deferred diagnostic will 9563 // be triggered if it is emitted. However a wrong-sided function is still 9564 // a viable candidate here. 9565 // 9566 // If Cand1 can be emitted and Cand2 cannot be emitted in the current 9567 // context, Cand1 is better than Cand2. If Cand1 can not be emitted and Cand2 9568 // can be emitted, Cand1 is not better than Cand2. This rule should have 9569 // precedence over other rules. 9570 // 9571 // If both Cand1 and Cand2 can be emitted, or neither can be emitted, then 9572 // other rules should be used to determine which is better. This is because 9573 // host/device based overloading resolution is mostly for determining 9574 // viability of a function. If two functions are both viable, other factors 9575 // should take precedence in preference, e.g. the standard-defined preferences 9576 // like argument conversion ranks or enable_if partial-ordering. The 9577 // preference for pass-object-size parameters is probably most similar to a 9578 // type-based-overloading decision and so should take priority. 9579 // 9580 // If other rules cannot determine which is better, CUDA preference will be 9581 // used again to determine which is better. 9582 // 9583 // TODO: Currently IdentifyCUDAPreference does not return correct values 9584 // for functions called in global variable initializers due to missing 9585 // correct context about device/host. Therefore we can only enforce this 9586 // rule when there is a caller. We should enforce this rule for functions 9587 // in global variable initializers once proper context is added. 9588 // 9589 // TODO: We can only enable the hostness based overloading resolution when 9590 // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is on since this requires deferring 9591 // overloading resolution diagnostics. 9592 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9593 S.getLangOpts().GPUExcludeWrongSideOverloads) { 9594 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) { 9595 bool IsCallerImplicitHD = Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Caller); 9596 bool IsCand1ImplicitHD = 9597 Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Cand1.Function); 9598 bool IsCand2ImplicitHD = 9599 Sema::isCUDAImplicitHostDeviceFunction(Cand2.Function); 9600 auto P1 = S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function); 9601 auto P2 = S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function); 9602 assert(P1 != Sema::CFP_Never && P2 != Sema::CFP_Never); 9603 // The implicit HD function may be a function in a system header which 9604 // is forced by pragma. In device compilation, if we prefer HD candidates 9605 // over wrong-sided candidates, overloading resolution may change, which 9606 // may result in non-deferrable diagnostics. As a workaround, we let 9607 // implicit HD candidates take equal preference as wrong-sided candidates. 9608 // This will preserve the overloading resolution. 9609 // TODO: We still need special handling of implicit HD functions since 9610 // they may incur other diagnostics to be deferred. We should make all 9611 // host/device related diagnostics deferrable and remove special handling 9612 // of implicit HD functions. 9613 auto EmitThreshold = 9614 (S.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice && IsCallerImplicitHD && 9615 (IsCand1ImplicitHD || IsCand2ImplicitHD)) 9616 ? Sema::CFP_Never 9617 : Sema::CFP_WrongSide; 9618 auto Cand1Emittable = P1 > EmitThreshold; 9619 auto Cand2Emittable = P2 > EmitThreshold; 9620 if (Cand1Emittable && !Cand2Emittable) 9621 return true; 9622 if (!Cand1Emittable && Cand2Emittable) 9623 return false; 9624 } 9625 } 9626 9627 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9628 // 9629 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 9630 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 9631 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 9632 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 9633 unsigned StartArg = 0; 9634 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 9635 StartArg = 1; 9636 9637 auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 9638 // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++. 9639 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 9640 return ICS.isStandard() && 9641 ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 9642 9643 // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to 9644 // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11. 9645 return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 9646 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS); 9647 }; 9648 9649 // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given 9650 // argument to be better candidates than functions that do. 9651 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size(); 9652 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 9653 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 9654 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9655 bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 9656 bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 9657 if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) { 9658 if (Cand1Bad) 9659 return false; 9660 HasBetterConversion = true; 9661 } 9662 } 9663 9664 if (HasBetterConversion) 9665 return true; 9666 9667 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9668 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 9669 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 9670 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 9671 bool HasWorseConversion = false; 9672 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9673 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9674 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 9675 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 9676 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 9677 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 9678 HasBetterConversion = true; 9679 break; 9680 9681 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 9682 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9683 Cand1.isReversed() != Cand2.isReversed() && 9684 haveSameParameterTypes(S.Context, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function, 9685 NumArgs)) { 9686 // Work around large-scale breakage caused by considering reversed 9687 // forms of operator== in C++20: 9688 // 9689 // When comparing a function against a reversed function with the same 9690 // parameter types, if we have a better conversion for one argument and 9691 // a worse conversion for the other, the implicit conversion sequences 9692 // are treated as being equally good. 9693 // 9694 // This prevents a comparison function from being considered ambiguous 9695 // with a reversed form that is written in the same way. 9696 // 9697 // We diagnose this as an extension from CreateOverloadedBinOp. 9698 HasWorseConversion = true; 9699 break; 9700 } 9701 9702 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 9703 return false; 9704 9705 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 9706 // Do nothing. 9707 break; 9708 } 9709 } 9710 9711 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 9712 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 9713 if (HasBetterConversion && !HasWorseConversion) 9714 return true; 9715 9716 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 9717 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 9718 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 9719 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 9720 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 9721 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 9722 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion && 9723 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9724 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 9725 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 9726 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the 9727 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension 9728 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function 9729 // pointer or block. 9730 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 9731 compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9732 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9733 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9734 Cand1.FinalConversion, 9735 Cand2.FinalConversion); 9736 9737 if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9738 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 9739 9740 // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions 9741 // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per 9742 // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3. 9743 } 9744 9745 // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording, 9746 // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243. 9747 // 9748 // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or 9749 // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over 9750 // a conversion function. 9751 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 && 9752 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9753 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) != 9754 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function)) 9755 return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9756 9757 // -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 9758 // specialization, or, if not that, 9759 bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function && 9760 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9761 bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function && 9762 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9763 if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization) 9764 return Cand2IsSpecialization; 9765 9766 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 9767 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 9768 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 9769 // if not that, 9770 if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) { 9771 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate( 9772 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 9773 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), Loc, 9774 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) ? TPOC_Conversion 9775 : TPOC_Call, 9776 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments, 9777 Cand1.isReversed() ^ Cand2.isReversed())) 9778 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9779 } 9780 9781 // -— F1 and F2 are non-template functions with the same 9782 // parameter-type-lists, and F1 is more constrained than F2 [...], 9783 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && !Cand1IsSpecialization && 9784 !Cand2IsSpecialization && Cand1.Function->hasPrototype() && 9785 Cand2.Function->hasPrototype()) { 9786 auto *PT1 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand1.Function->getFunctionType()); 9787 auto *PT2 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand2.Function->getFunctionType()); 9788 if (PT1->getNumParams() == PT2->getNumParams() && 9789 PT1->isVariadic() == PT2->isVariadic() && 9790 S.FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(PT1, PT2)) { 9791 Expr *RC1 = Cand1.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 9792 Expr *RC2 = Cand2.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 9793 if (RC1 && RC2) { 9794 bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2; 9795 if (S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand1.Function, {RC1}, Cand2.Function, 9796 {RC2}, AtLeastAsConstrained1) || 9797 S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand2.Function, {RC2}, Cand1.Function, 9798 {RC1}, AtLeastAsConstrained2)) 9799 return false; 9800 if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 != AtLeastAsConstrained2) 9801 return AtLeastAsConstrained1; 9802 } else if (RC1 || RC2) { 9803 return RC1 != nullptr; 9804 } 9805 } 9806 } 9807 9808 // -- F1 is a constructor for a class D, F2 is a constructor for a base 9809 // class B of D, and for all arguments the corresponding parameters of 9810 // F1 and F2 have the same type. 9811 // FIXME: Implement the "all parameters have the same type" check. 9812 bool Cand1IsInherited = 9813 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9814 bool Cand2IsInherited = 9815 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9816 if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited) 9817 return Cand2IsInherited; 9818 else if (Cand1IsInherited) { 9819 assert(Cand2IsInherited); 9820 auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext()); 9821 auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext()); 9822 if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class)) 9823 return true; 9824 if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class)) 9825 return false; 9826 // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous. 9827 } 9828 9829 // -- F2 is a rewritten candidate (12.4.1.2) and F1 is not 9830 // -- F1 and F2 are rewritten candidates, and F2 is a synthesized candidate 9831 // with reversed order of parameters and F1 is not 9832 // 9833 // We rank reversed + different operator as worse than just reversed, but 9834 // that comparison can never happen, because we only consider reversing for 9835 // the maximally-rewritten operator (== or <=>). 9836 if (Cand1.RewriteKind != Cand2.RewriteKind) 9837 return Cand1.RewriteKind < Cand2.RewriteKind; 9838 9839 // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides. 9840 { 9841 auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9842 auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function); 9843 if (Guide1 && Guide2) { 9844 // -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not 9845 if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit()) 9846 return Guide2->isImplicit(); 9847 9848 // -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not 9849 if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate()) 9850 return true; 9851 } 9852 } 9853 9854 // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution. 9855 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9856 Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9857 if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal) 9858 return Cmp == Comparison::Better; 9859 } 9860 9861 bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr && 9862 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function); 9863 bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr && 9864 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function); 9865 if (HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1) 9866 return true; 9867 9868 auto MV = isBetterMultiversionCandidate(Cand1, Cand2); 9869 if (MV == Comparison::Better) 9870 return true; 9871 if (MV == Comparison::Worse) 9872 return false; 9873 9874 // If other rules cannot determine which is better, CUDA preference is used 9875 // to determine which is better. 9876 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9877 FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9878 return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) > 9879 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function); 9880 } 9881 9882 return false; 9883 } 9884 9885 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of 9886 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no 9887 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including 9888 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to 9889 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both 9890 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using 9891 /// a modularized libstdc++). 9892 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A, 9893 const NamedDecl *B) { 9894 auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A); 9895 auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B); 9896 if (!VA || !VB) 9897 return false; 9898 9899 // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage 9900 // entity in different modules. 9901 if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 9902 VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) || 9903 getOwningModule(VA) == getOwningModule(VB) || 9904 VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible()) 9905 return false; 9906 9907 // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent. 9908 // 9909 // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity. 9910 // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is 9911 // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all. 9912 if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType())) 9913 return true; 9914 9915 // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but 9916 // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes. 9917 if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) { 9918 if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) { 9919 // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and 9920 // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type. 9921 auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext()); 9922 auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext()); 9923 if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() || 9924 !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(), 9925 EnumB->getIntegerType())) 9926 return false; 9927 // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators. 9928 return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal()); 9929 } 9930 } 9931 9932 // Nothing else is sufficiently similar. 9933 return false; 9934 } 9935 9936 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations( 9937 SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) { 9938 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D; 9939 9940 Module *M = getOwningModule(D); 9941 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9942 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9943 9944 for (auto *E : Equiv) { 9945 Module *M = getOwningModule(E); 9946 Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9947 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9948 } 9949 } 9950 9951 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 9952 /// within an overload candidate set. 9953 /// 9954 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 9955 /// which overload resolution occurs. 9956 /// 9957 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 9958 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found. 9959 /// 9960 /// \returns The result of overload resolution. 9961 OverloadingResult 9962 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9963 iterator &Best) { 9964 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates; 9965 std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates), 9966 [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; }); 9967 9968 // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but 9969 // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular 9970 // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to 9971 // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based 9972 // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one 9973 // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore 9974 // the WrongSide candidate. 9975 // We only need to remove wrong-sided candidates here if 9976 // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is off. When 9977 // -fgpu-exclude-wrong-side-overloads is on, all candidates are compared 9978 // uniformly in isBetterOverloadCandidate. 9979 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && !S.getLangOpts().GPUExcludeWrongSideOverloads) { 9980 const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9981 bool ContainsSameSideCandidate = 9982 llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9983 // Check viable function only. 9984 return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function && 9985 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9986 Sema::CFP_SameSide; 9987 }); 9988 if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) { 9989 auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9990 // Check viable function only to avoid unnecessary data copying/moving. 9991 return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function && 9992 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9993 Sema::CFP_WrongSide; 9994 }; 9995 llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate); 9996 } 9997 } 9998 9999 // Find the best viable function. 10000 Best = end(); 10001 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 10002 Cand->Best = false; 10003 if (Cand->Viable) 10004 if (Best == end() || 10005 isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind)) 10006 Best = Cand; 10007 } 10008 10009 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 10010 if (Best == end()) 10011 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 10012 10013 llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands; 10014 10015 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 4> PendingBest; 10016 PendingBest.push_back(&*Best); 10017 Best->Best = true; 10018 10019 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 10020 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 10021 while (!PendingBest.empty()) { 10022 auto *Curr = PendingBest.pop_back_val(); 10023 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 10024 if (Cand->Viable && !Cand->Best && 10025 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Curr, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) { 10026 PendingBest.push_back(Cand); 10027 Cand->Best = true; 10028 10029 if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Cand->Function, 10030 Curr->Function)) 10031 EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function); 10032 else 10033 Best = end(); 10034 } 10035 } 10036 } 10037 10038 // If we found more than one best candidate, this is ambiguous. 10039 if (Best == end()) 10040 return OR_Ambiguous; 10041 10042 // Best is the best viable function. 10043 if (Best->Function && Best->Function->isDeleted()) 10044 return OR_Deleted; 10045 10046 if (!EquivalentCands.empty()) 10047 S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function, 10048 EquivalentCands); 10049 10050 return OR_Success; 10051 } 10052 10053 namespace { 10054 10055 enum OverloadCandidateKind { 10056 oc_function, 10057 oc_method, 10058 oc_reversed_binary_operator, 10059 oc_constructor, 10060 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 10061 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 10062 oc_implicit_move_constructor, 10063 oc_implicit_copy_assignment, 10064 oc_implicit_move_assignment, 10065 oc_implicit_equality_comparison, 10066 oc_inherited_constructor 10067 }; 10068 10069 enum OverloadCandidateSelect { 10070 ocs_non_template, 10071 ocs_template, 10072 ocs_described_template, 10073 }; 10074 10075 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> 10076 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 10077 OverloadCandidateRewriteKind CRK, 10078 std::string &Description) { 10079 10080 bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl(); 10081 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 10082 isTemplate = true; 10083 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10084 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 10085 } 10086 10087 OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() { 10088 if (!Description.empty()) 10089 return ocs_described_template; 10090 return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template; 10091 }(); 10092 10093 OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() { 10094 if (Fn->isImplicit() && Fn->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_EqualEqual) 10095 return oc_implicit_equality_comparison; 10096 10097 if (CRK & CRK_Reversed) 10098 return oc_reversed_binary_operator; 10099 10100 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 10101 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) { 10102 if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 10103 return oc_inherited_constructor; 10104 else 10105 return oc_constructor; 10106 } 10107 10108 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 10109 return oc_implicit_default_constructor; 10110 10111 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 10112 return oc_implicit_move_constructor; 10113 10114 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() && 10115 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor"); 10116 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor; 10117 } 10118 10119 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 10120 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 10121 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 10122 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 10123 return oc_method; 10124 10125 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 10126 return oc_implicit_move_assignment; 10127 10128 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 10129 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 10130 10131 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion"); 10132 return oc_method; 10133 } 10134 10135 return oc_function; 10136 }(); 10137 10138 return std::make_pair(Kind, Select); 10139 } 10140 10141 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) { 10142 // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload 10143 // set. 10144 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)) 10145 S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(), 10146 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor) 10147 << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass(); 10148 } 10149 10150 } // end anonymous namespace 10151 10152 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx, 10153 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10154 for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) { 10155 bool AlwaysTrue; 10156 if (EnableIf->getCond()->isValueDependent() || 10157 !EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx)) 10158 return false; 10159 if (!AlwaysTrue) 10160 return false; 10161 } 10162 return true; 10163 } 10164 10165 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function. 10166 /// 10167 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic 10168 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are 10169 /// we in overload resolution? 10170 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored 10171 /// if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution. 10172 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD, 10173 bool Complain, 10174 bool InOverloadResolution, 10175 SourceLocation Loc) { 10176 if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) { 10177 if (Complain) { 10178 if (InOverloadResolution) 10179 S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(), 10180 diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr); 10181 else 10182 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD; 10183 } 10184 return false; 10185 } 10186 10187 if (FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 10188 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 10189 if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc)) 10190 return false; 10191 if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 10192 if (Complain) { 10193 if (InOverloadResolution) 10194 S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(), 10195 diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints); 10196 else 10197 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_constraints_not_satisfied) 10198 << FD; 10199 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction); 10200 } 10201 return false; 10202 } 10203 } 10204 10205 auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 10206 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 10207 }); 10208 if (I == FD->param_end()) 10209 return true; 10210 10211 if (Complain) { 10212 // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing 10213 unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1; 10214 if (InOverloadResolution) 10215 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 10216 diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params) 10217 << ParamNo; 10218 else 10219 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params) 10220 << FD << ParamNo; 10221 } 10222 return false; 10223 } 10224 10225 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S, 10226 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10227 return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true, 10228 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 10229 /*Loc=*/SourceLocation()); 10230 } 10231 10232 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function, 10233 bool Complain, 10234 SourceLocation Loc) { 10235 return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain, 10236 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 10237 Loc); 10238 } 10239 10240 // Don't print candidates other than the one that matches the calling 10241 // convention of the call operator, since that is guaranteed to exist. 10242 static bool shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(FunctionDecl *Fn) { 10243 const auto *ConvD = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Fn); 10244 10245 if (!ConvD) 10246 return false; 10247 const auto *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Fn->getParent()); 10248 if (!RD->isLambda()) 10249 return false; 10250 10251 CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = RD->getLambdaCallOperator(); 10252 CallingConv CallOpCC = 10253 CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 10254 QualType ConvRTy = ConvD->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(); 10255 CallingConv ConvToCC = 10256 ConvRTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 10257 10258 return ConvToCC != CallOpCC; 10259 } 10260 10261 // Notes the location of an overload candidate. 10262 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 10263 OverloadCandidateRewriteKind RewriteKind, 10264 QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) { 10265 if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn)) 10266 return; 10267 if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && Fn->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 10268 !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) 10269 return; 10270 if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Fn)) 10271 return; 10272 10273 std::string FnDesc; 10274 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair = 10275 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, RewriteKind, FnDesc); 10276 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 10277 << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second 10278 << Fn << FnDesc; 10279 10280 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType); 10281 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD); 10282 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found); 10283 } 10284 10285 static void 10286 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(Sema &S, ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate> Cands) { 10287 // Perhaps the ambiguity was caused by two atomic constraints that are 10288 // 'identical' but not equivalent: 10289 // 10290 // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) { } // #1 10291 // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) && T::value { } // #2 10292 // 10293 // The 'sizeof(T) > 4' constraints are seemingly equivalent and should cause 10294 // #2 to subsume #1, but these constraint are not considered equivalent 10295 // according to the subsumption rules because they are not the same 10296 // source-level construct. This behavior is quite confusing and we should try 10297 // to help the user figure out what happened. 10298 10299 SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> FirstAC, SecondAC; 10300 FunctionDecl *FirstCand = nullptr, *SecondCand = nullptr; 10301 for (auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10302 if (!I->Function) 10303 continue; 10304 SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> AC; 10305 if (auto *Template = I->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 10306 Template->getAssociatedConstraints(AC); 10307 else 10308 I->Function->getAssociatedConstraints(AC); 10309 if (AC.empty()) 10310 continue; 10311 if (FirstCand == nullptr) { 10312 FirstCand = I->Function; 10313 FirstAC = AC; 10314 } else if (SecondCand == nullptr) { 10315 SecondCand = I->Function; 10316 SecondAC = AC; 10317 } else { 10318 // We have more than one pair of constrained functions - this check is 10319 // expensive and we'd rather not try to diagnose it. 10320 return; 10321 } 10322 } 10323 if (!SecondCand) 10324 return; 10325 // The diagnostic can only happen if there are associated constraints on 10326 // both sides (there needs to be some identical atomic constraint). 10327 if (S.MaybeEmitAmbiguousAtomicConstraintsDiagnostic(FirstCand, FirstAC, 10328 SecondCand, SecondAC)) 10329 // Just show the user one diagnostic, they'll probably figure it out 10330 // from here. 10331 return; 10332 } 10333 10334 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through 10335 // OverloadedExpr 10336 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType, 10337 bool TakingAddress) { 10338 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 10339 10340 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr); 10341 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 10342 10343 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 10344 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 10345 I != IEnd; ++I) { 10346 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = 10347 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 10348 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), CRK_None, DestType, 10349 TakingAddress); 10350 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun 10351 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 10352 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, DestType, TakingAddress); 10353 } 10354 } 10355 } 10356 10357 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 10358 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 10359 /// target types of the conversion. 10360 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 10361 Sema &S, 10362 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 10363 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 10364 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 10365 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 10366 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from 10367 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for 10368 // refactoring here. 10369 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 10370 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 10371 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E; 10372 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10373 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 10374 break; 10375 ++CandsShown; 10376 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second); 10377 } 10378 if (I != E) 10379 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 10380 } 10381 10382 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10383 unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10384 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 10385 assert(Conv.isBad()); 10386 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 10387 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10388 10389 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 10390 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 10391 // conversion-slot index. 10392 bool isObjectArgument = false; 10393 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 10394 if (I == 0) 10395 isObjectArgument = true; 10396 else 10397 I--; 10398 } 10399 10400 std::string FnDesc; 10401 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10402 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind(), 10403 FnDesc); 10404 10405 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 10406 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 10407 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 10408 10409 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 10410 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 10411 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 10412 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 10413 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 10414 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 10415 10416 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 10417 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10418 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy 10419 << Name << I + 1; 10420 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10421 return; 10422 } 10423 10424 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 10425 // to a qualifier mismatch. 10426 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 10427 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 10428 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 10429 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 10430 else { 10431 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 10432 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 10433 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10434 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(); 10435 CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 10436 } 10437 } 10438 10439 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 10440 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 10441 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 10442 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 10443 10444 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 10445 if (isObjectArgument) 10446 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace_this) 10447 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10448 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10449 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace(); 10450 else 10451 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 10452 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10453 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10454 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace() 10455 << ToTy->isReferenceType() << I + 1; 10456 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10457 return; 10458 } 10459 10460 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 10461 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership) 10462 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10463 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10464 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime() 10465 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10466 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10467 return; 10468 } 10469 10470 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) { 10471 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc) 10472 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10473 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10474 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr() 10475 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10476 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10477 return; 10478 } 10479 10480 if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) { 10481 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned) 10482 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10483 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10484 << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1; 10485 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10486 return; 10487 } 10488 10489 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 10490 assert(CVR && "expected qualifiers mismatch"); 10491 10492 if (isObjectArgument) { 10493 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 10494 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10495 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10496 << (CVR - 1); 10497 } else { 10498 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 10499 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10500 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10501 << (CVR - 1) << I + 1; 10502 } 10503 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10504 return; 10505 } 10506 10507 if (Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue || 10508 Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue) { 10509 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_value_category) 10510 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10511 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10512 << (Conv.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue) 10513 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 10514 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10515 return; 10516 } 10517 10518 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since 10519 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful. 10520 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) { 10521 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument) 10522 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10523 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10524 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10525 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10526 return; 10527 } 10528 10529 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 10530 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 10531 // the failure. 10532 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 10533 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 10534 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 10535 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 10536 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 10537 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 10538 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10539 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10540 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10541 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 10542 10543 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10544 return; 10545 } 10546 10547 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 10548 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 10549 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10550 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10551 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 10552 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 10553 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10554 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10555 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 10556 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 10557 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 10558 } 10559 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 10560 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 10561 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 10562 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 10563 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 10564 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 10565 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 10566 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 10567 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 10568 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 10569 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 10570 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 10571 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 10572 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10573 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) { 10574 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 10575 } 10576 } 10577 10578 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 10579 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 10580 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10581 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10582 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1; 10583 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10584 return; 10585 } 10586 10587 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) && 10588 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) { 10589 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 10590 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 10591 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 10592 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv) 10593 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10594 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10595 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10596 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10597 return; 10598 } 10599 } 10600 10601 if (TakingCandidateAddress && 10602 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function)) 10603 return; 10604 10605 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 10606 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv); 10607 FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10608 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10609 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10610 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 10611 10612 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 10613 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), 10614 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 10615 FDiag << *HI; 10616 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag); 10617 10618 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10619 } 10620 10621 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload 10622 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch() 10623 /// over a candidate in any candidate set. 10624 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10625 unsigned NumArgs) { 10626 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10627 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 10628 10629 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we 10630 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the 10631 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have 10632 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions. 10633 // Just don't report anything. 10634 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() && 10635 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) 10636 return true; 10637 10638 if (NumArgs < MinParams) { 10639 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 10640 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 10641 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 10642 } else { 10643 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 10644 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 10645 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 10646 } 10647 10648 return false; 10649 } 10650 10651 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set. 10652 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D, 10653 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 10654 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 10655 "The templated declaration should at least be a function" 10656 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many" 10657 " or too few arguments"); 10658 10659 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 10660 10661 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 10662 const auto *FnTy = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10663 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 10664 10665 // at least / at most / exactly 10666 unsigned mode, modeCount; 10667 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 10668 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() || 10669 FnTy->isTemplateVariadic()) 10670 mode = 0; // "at least" 10671 else 10672 mode = 2; // "exactly" 10673 modeCount = MinParams; 10674 } else { 10675 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams()) 10676 mode = 1; // "at most" 10677 else 10678 mode = 2; // "exactly" 10679 modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams(); 10680 } 10681 10682 std::string Description; 10683 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10684 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, CRK_None, Description); 10685 10686 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 10687 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one) 10688 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10689 << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs; 10690 else 10691 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 10692 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10693 << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 10694 10695 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10696 } 10697 10698 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate. 10699 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10700 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 10701 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs)) 10702 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs); 10703 } 10704 10705 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) { 10706 if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate()) 10707 return TD; 10708 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration" 10709 " for bad deduction diagnosis"); 10710 } 10711 10712 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 10713 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated, 10714 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure, 10715 unsigned NumArgs, 10716 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10717 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 10718 NamedDecl *ParamD; 10719 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 10720 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 10721 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 10722 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) { 10723 case Sema::TDK_Success: 10724 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 10725 10726 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 10727 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 10728 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10729 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 10730 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 10731 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10732 return; 10733 } 10734 10735 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: { 10736 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 10737 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10738 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction_pack) 10739 << ParamD->getDeclName() 10740 << (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() + 1) 10741 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10742 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10743 return; 10744 } 10745 10746 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 10747 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 10748 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 10749 10750 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 10751 10752 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 10753 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 10754 QualifierCollector Qs; 10755 Qs.strip(Param); 10756 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 10757 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 10758 10759 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 10760 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 10761 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 10762 // done on dependent types). 10763 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 10764 10765 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 10766 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 10767 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10768 return; 10769 } 10770 10771 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 10772 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 10773 int which = 0; 10774 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10775 which = 0; 10776 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) { 10777 // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two 10778 // different types for a non-type template parameter. 10779 // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this. 10780 QualType T1 = 10781 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 10782 QualType T2 = 10783 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 10784 if (!T1.isNull() && !T2.isNull() && !S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) { 10785 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10786 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types) 10787 << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1 10788 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2; 10789 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10790 return; 10791 } 10792 10793 which = 1; 10794 } else { 10795 which = 2; 10796 } 10797 10798 // Tweak the diagnostic if the problem is that we deduced packs of 10799 // different arities. We'll print the actual packs anyway in case that 10800 // includes additional useful information. 10801 if (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack && 10802 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack && 10803 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() != 10804 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->pack_size()) { 10805 which = 3; 10806 } 10807 10808 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10809 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 10810 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 10811 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10812 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10813 return; 10814 } 10815 10816 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 10817 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 10818 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 10819 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10820 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 10821 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 10822 else { 10823 int index = 0; 10824 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10825 index = TTP->getIndex(); 10826 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 10827 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10828 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 10829 else 10830 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 10831 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10832 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 10833 << (index + 1); 10834 } 10835 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10836 return; 10837 10838 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: { 10839 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10840 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10841 TemplateArgumentList *Args = DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList(); 10842 TemplateArgString = " "; 10843 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10844 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10845 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10846 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10847 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10848 diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints) 10849 << TemplateArgString; 10850 10851 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint( 10852 static_cast<CNSInfo*>(DeductionFailure.Data)->Satisfaction); 10853 return; 10854 } 10855 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 10856 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 10857 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs); 10858 return; 10859 10860 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 10861 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10862 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 10863 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10864 return; 10865 10866 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 10867 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10868 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10869 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10870 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10871 TemplateArgString = " "; 10872 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10873 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10874 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10875 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10876 } 10877 10878 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so. 10879 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic(); 10880 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 10881 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) { 10882 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified 10883 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag. 10884 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if) 10885 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString; 10886 return; 10887 } 10888 10889 // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if. 10890 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 10891 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) { 10892 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10893 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement) 10894 << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString; 10895 return; 10896 } 10897 10898 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string. 10899 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s 10900 // formatted message in another diagnostic. 10901 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString; 10902 SourceRange R; 10903 if (PDiag) { 10904 SFINAEArgString = ": "; 10905 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first); 10906 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString); 10907 } 10908 10909 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10910 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 10911 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R; 10912 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10913 return; 10914 } 10915 10916 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 10917 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 10918 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10919 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10920 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10921 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10922 TemplateArgString = " "; 10923 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10924 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10925 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10926 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10927 } 10928 10929 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch) 10930 << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1) 10931 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() 10932 << TemplateArgString 10933 << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested); 10934 break; 10935 } 10936 10937 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 10938 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match. 10939 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10940 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10941 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template && 10942 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) { 10943 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate(); 10944 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate(); 10945 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template && 10946 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) { 10947 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() == 10948 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) { 10949 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named 10950 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since: 10951 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer. 10952 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better 10953 // name for types, not decls. 10954 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer. 10955 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10956 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified) 10957 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 10958 return; 10959 } 10960 } 10961 } 10962 10963 if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) && 10964 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))) 10965 return; 10966 10967 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda 10968 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative 10969 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to 10970 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters. 10971 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10972 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch) 10973 << FirstTA << SecondTA; 10974 return; 10975 } 10976 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 10977 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 10978 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 10979 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 10980 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10981 return; 10982 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 10983 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10984 diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch); 10985 return; 10986 } 10987 } 10988 10989 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls. 10990 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10991 unsigned NumArgs, 10992 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10993 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result; 10994 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) { 10995 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs)) 10996 return; 10997 } 10998 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern 10999 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress); 11000 } 11001 11002 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets. 11003 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11004 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 11005 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 11006 11007 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 11008 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 11009 11010 std::string FnDesc; 11011 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 11012 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee, 11013 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 11014 11015 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target) 11016 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 11017 << FnDesc /* Ignored */ 11018 << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget; 11019 11020 // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the 11021 // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case. 11022 CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee); 11023 if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) { 11024 CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent(); 11025 Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM; 11026 11027 switch (FnKindPair.first) { 11028 default: 11029 return; 11030 case oc_implicit_default_constructor: 11031 CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor; 11032 break; 11033 case oc_implicit_copy_constructor: 11034 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor; 11035 break; 11036 case oc_implicit_move_constructor: 11037 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor; 11038 break; 11039 case oc_implicit_copy_assignment: 11040 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment; 11041 break; 11042 case oc_implicit_move_assignment: 11043 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment; 11044 break; 11045 }; 11046 11047 bool ConstRHS = false; 11048 if (Meth->getNumParams()) { 11049 if (const ReferenceType *RT = 11050 Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 11051 ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified(); 11052 } 11053 } 11054 11055 S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth, 11056 /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS, 11057 /* Diagnose */ true); 11058 } 11059 } 11060 11061 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11062 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 11063 EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data); 11064 11065 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 11066 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 11067 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 11068 } 11069 11070 static void DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11071 ExplicitSpecifier ES = ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Cand->Function); 11072 assert(ES.isExplicit() && "not an explicit candidate"); 11073 11074 unsigned Kind; 11075 switch (Cand->Function->getDeclKind()) { 11076 case Decl::Kind::CXXConstructor: 11077 Kind = 0; 11078 break; 11079 case Decl::Kind::CXXConversion: 11080 Kind = 1; 11081 break; 11082 case Decl::Kind::CXXDeductionGuide: 11083 Kind = Cand->Function->isImplicit() ? 0 : 2; 11084 break; 11085 default: 11086 llvm_unreachable("invalid Decl"); 11087 } 11088 11089 // Note the location of the first (in-class) declaration; a redeclaration 11090 // (particularly an out-of-class definition) will typically lack the 11091 // 'explicit' specifier. 11092 // FIXME: This is probably a good thing to do for all 'candidate' notes. 11093 FunctionDecl *First = Cand->Function->getFirstDecl(); 11094 if (FunctionDecl *Pattern = First->getTemplateInstantiationPattern()) 11095 First = Pattern->getFirstDecl(); 11096 11097 S.Diag(First->getLocation(), 11098 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit) 11099 << Kind << (ES.getExpr() ? 1 : 0) 11100 << (ES.getExpr() ? ES.getExpr()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 11101 } 11102 11103 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11104 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 11105 11106 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 11107 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension) 11108 << S.getOpenCLExtensionsFromDeclExtMap(Callee); 11109 } 11110 11111 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 11112 /// already generated a primary error at the call site. 11113 /// 11114 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 11115 /// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 11116 /// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 11117 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 11118 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 11119 /// overload. 11120 /// 11121 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 11122 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 11123 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 11124 /// \param CtorDestAS Addr space of object being constructed (for ctor 11125 /// candidates only). 11126 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 11127 unsigned NumArgs, 11128 bool TakingCandidateAddress, 11129 LangAS CtorDestAS = LangAS::Default) { 11130 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 11131 if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Fn)) 11132 return; 11133 11134 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 11135 if (Cand->Viable) { 11136 if (Fn->isDeleted()) { 11137 std::string FnDesc; 11138 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 11139 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, 11140 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 11141 11142 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 11143 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 11144 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0); 11145 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11146 return; 11147 } 11148 11149 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 11150 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11151 return; 11152 } 11153 11154 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 11155 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 11156 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 11157 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 11158 11159 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 11160 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs, 11161 TakingCandidateAddress); 11162 11163 case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: { 11164 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor) 11165 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0); 11166 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11167 return; 11168 } 11169 11170 case ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch: { 11171 Qualifiers QualsForPrinting; 11172 QualsForPrinting.setAddressSpace(CtorDestAS); 11173 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11174 diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor_adrspace_mismatch) 11175 << QualsForPrinting; 11176 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11177 return; 11178 } 11179 11180 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 11181 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 11182 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 11183 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11184 11185 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 11186 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 11187 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I) 11188 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 11189 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress); 11190 11191 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 11192 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 11193 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 11194 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11195 } 11196 11197 case ovl_fail_bad_target: 11198 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand); 11199 11200 case ovl_fail_enable_if: 11201 return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand); 11202 11203 case ovl_fail_explicit: 11204 return DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(S, Cand); 11205 11206 case ovl_fail_ext_disabled: 11207 return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand); 11208 11209 case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice: 11210 // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here. 11211 if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor()) 11212 return; 11213 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11214 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice) 11215 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0) 11216 << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType(); 11217 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11218 return; 11219 11220 case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: { 11221 bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function); 11222 (void)Available; 11223 assert(!Available); 11224 break; 11225 } 11226 case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function: 11227 // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored. 11228 break; 11229 11230 case ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied: { 11231 std::string FnDesc; 11232 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 11233 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, 11234 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 11235 11236 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11237 diag::note_ovl_candidate_constraints_not_satisfied) 11238 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 11239 << FnDesc /* Ignored */; 11240 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 11241 if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(Fn, Satisfaction)) 11242 break; 11243 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction); 11244 } 11245 } 11246 } 11247 11248 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11249 if (shouldSkipNotingLambdaConversionDecl(Cand->Surrogate)) 11250 return; 11251 11252 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 11253 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 11254 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 11255 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 11256 bool isLValueReference = false; 11257 bool isRValueReference = false; 11258 bool isPointer = false; 11259 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 11260 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 11261 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11262 isLValueReference = true; 11263 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 11264 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 11265 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11266 isRValueReference = true; 11267 } 11268 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 11269 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11270 isPointer = true; 11271 } 11272 // Desugar down to a function type. 11273 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 11274 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 11275 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 11276 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 11277 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 11278 11279 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 11280 << FnType; 11281 } 11282 11283 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc, 11284 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11285 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11286 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 11287 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 11288 TypeStr += Opc; 11289 TypeStr += "("; 11290 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 11291 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) { 11292 TypeStr += ")"; 11293 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr; 11294 } else { 11295 TypeStr += ", "; 11296 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 11297 TypeStr += ")"; 11298 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr; 11299 } 11300 } 11301 11302 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11303 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11304 for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) { 11305 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 11306 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 11307 11308 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 11309 S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 11310 } 11311 } 11312 11313 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11314 if (Cand->Function) 11315 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 11316 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 11317 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 11318 return SourceLocation(); 11319 } 11320 11321 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) { 11322 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) { 11323 case Sema::TDK_Success: 11324 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 11325 llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction"); 11326 11327 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 11328 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 11329 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 11330 return 1; 11331 11332 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 11333 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 11334 return 2; 11335 11336 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 11337 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 11338 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 11339 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 11340 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 11341 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 11342 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 11343 return 3; 11344 11345 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 11346 return 4; 11347 11348 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 11349 return 5; 11350 11351 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 11352 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 11353 return 6; 11354 } 11355 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result"); 11356 } 11357 11358 namespace { 11359 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 11360 Sema &S; 11361 SourceLocation Loc; 11362 size_t NumArgs; 11363 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK; 11364 11365 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay( 11366 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs, 11367 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) 11368 : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {} 11369 11370 OverloadFailureKind EffectiveFailureKind(const OverloadCandidate *C) const { 11371 // If there are too many or too few arguments, that's the high-order bit we 11372 // want to sort by, even if the immediate failure kind was something else. 11373 if (C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11374 C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 11375 return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind); 11376 11377 if (C->Function) { 11378 if (NumArgs > C->Function->getNumParams() && !C->Function->isVariadic()) 11379 return ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 11380 if (NumArgs < C->Function->getMinRequiredArguments()) 11381 return ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 11382 } 11383 11384 return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind); 11385 } 11386 11387 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 11388 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 11389 // Fast-path this check. 11390 if (L == R) return false; 11391 11392 // Order first by viability. 11393 if (L->Viable) { 11394 if (!R->Viable) return true; 11395 11396 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 11397 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 11398 // that could exploit it. 11399 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 11400 return true; 11401 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 11402 return false; 11403 } else if (R->Viable) 11404 return false; 11405 11406 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 11407 11408 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 11409 if (!L->Viable) { 11410 OverloadFailureKind LFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(L); 11411 OverloadFailureKind RFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(R); 11412 11413 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 11414 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11415 LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 11416 if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11417 RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 11418 int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 11419 int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 11420 if (LDist == RDist) { 11421 if (LFailureKind == RFailureKind) 11422 // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates. 11423 return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate; 11424 // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were 11425 // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters 11426 // than there were arguments given. 11427 return LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 11428 } 11429 return LDist < RDist; 11430 } 11431 return false; 11432 } 11433 if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11434 RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 11435 return true; 11436 11437 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 11438 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 11439 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 11440 if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11441 return true; 11442 11443 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes, 11444 // comes first. 11445 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 11446 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 11447 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes; 11448 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes; 11449 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) { 11450 return numLFixes < numRFixes; 11451 } 11452 11453 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 11454 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 11455 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size()); 11456 11457 int leftBetter = 0; 11458 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 11459 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) { 11460 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 11461 L->Conversions[I], 11462 R->Conversions[I])) { 11463 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 11464 leftBetter++; 11465 break; 11466 11467 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 11468 leftBetter--; 11469 break; 11470 11471 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 11472 break; 11473 } 11474 } 11475 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 11476 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 11477 11478 } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11479 return false; 11480 11481 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) { 11482 if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 11483 return true; 11484 11485 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 11486 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) 11487 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 11488 } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 11489 return false; 11490 11491 // TODO: others? 11492 } 11493 11494 // Sort everything else by location. 11495 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 11496 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 11497 11498 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 11499 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 11500 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 11501 11502 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 11503 } 11504 }; 11505 } 11506 11507 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 11508 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if 11509 /// possible. 11510 static void 11511 CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 11512 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11513 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) { 11514 assert(!Cand->Viable); 11515 11516 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 11517 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11518 return; 11519 11520 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected. 11521 bool Unfixable = false; 11522 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes. 11523 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization); 11524 11525 // Attempt to fix the bad conversion. 11526 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size(); 11527 for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/; 11528 ++ConvIdx) { 11529 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 11530 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 11531 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 11532 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 11533 break; 11534 } 11535 } 11536 11537 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 11538 // operation somehow. 11539 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 11540 11541 unsigned ConvIdx = 0; 11542 unsigned ArgIdx = 0; 11543 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes; 11544 bool Reversed = Cand->isReversed(); 11545 11546 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 11547 QualType ConvType 11548 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 11549 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11550 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 11551 ParamTypes = ConvType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 11552 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11553 ConvIdx = 1; 11554 } else if (Cand->Function) { 11555 ParamTypes = 11556 Cand->Function->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 11557 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 11558 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function) && !Reversed) { 11559 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11560 ConvIdx = 1; 11561 if (CSK == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 11562 Cand->Function->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Call) 11563 // Argument 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11564 ArgIdx = 1; 11565 } 11566 } else { 11567 // Builtin operator. 11568 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 11569 ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes; 11570 } 11571 11572 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 11573 for (unsigned ParamIdx = Reversed ? ParamTypes.size() - 1 : 0; 11574 ConvIdx != ConvCount; 11575 ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx, ParamIdx += (Reversed ? -1 : 1)) { 11576 assert(ArgIdx < Args.size() && "no argument for this arg conversion"); 11577 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 11578 // We've already checked this conversion. 11579 } else if (ParamIdx < ParamTypes.size()) { 11580 if (ParamTypes[ParamIdx]->isDependentType()) 11581 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion( 11582 Args[ArgIdx]->getType()); 11583 else { 11584 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = 11585 TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ParamIdx], 11586 SuppressUserConversions, 11587 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 11588 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 11589 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 11590 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists. 11591 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 11592 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 11593 } 11594 } else 11595 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 11596 } 11597 } 11598 11599 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 32> OverloadCandidateSet::CompleteCandidates( 11600 Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11601 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11602 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 11603 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 11604 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 11605 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 11606 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 11607 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 11608 if (!Filter(*Cand)) 11609 continue; 11610 switch (OCD) { 11611 case OCD_AllCandidates: 11612 if (!Cand->Viable) { 11613 if (!Cand->Function && !Cand->IsSurrogate) { 11614 // This a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 11615 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 11616 continue; 11617 } 11618 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, Kind); 11619 } 11620 break; 11621 11622 case OCD_ViableCandidates: 11623 if (!Cand->Viable) 11624 continue; 11625 break; 11626 11627 case OCD_AmbiguousCandidates: 11628 if (!Cand->Best) 11629 continue; 11630 break; 11631 } 11632 11633 Cands.push_back(Cand); 11634 } 11635 11636 llvm::stable_sort( 11637 Cands, CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind)); 11638 11639 return Cands; 11640 } 11641 11642 bool OverloadCandidateSet::shouldDeferDiags(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11643 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11644 bool DeferHint = false; 11645 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().GPUDeferDiag) { 11646 // Defer diagnostic for CUDA/HIP if there are wrong-sided candidates or 11647 // host device candidates. 11648 auto WrongSidedCands = 11649 CompleteCandidates(S, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, OpLoc, [](auto &Cand) { 11650 return (Cand.Viable == false && 11651 Cand.FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_target) || 11652 (Cand.Function->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>() && 11653 Cand.Function->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>()); 11654 }); 11655 DeferHint = WrongSidedCands.size(); 11656 } 11657 return DeferHint; 11658 } 11659 11660 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the 11661 /// candidates in the candidate set. 11662 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates( 11663 PartialDiagnosticAt PD, Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, 11664 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11665 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 11666 11667 auto Cands = CompleteCandidates(S, OCD, Args, OpLoc, Filter); 11668 11669 S.Diag(PD.first, PD.second, shouldDeferDiags(S, Args, OpLoc)); 11670 11671 NoteCandidates(S, Args, Cands, Opc, OpLoc); 11672 11673 if (OCD == OCD_AmbiguousCandidates) 11674 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(S, {begin(), end()}); 11675 } 11676 11677 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11678 ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate *> Cands, 11679 StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11680 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 11681 11682 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 11683 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 11684 auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); 11685 for (; I != E; ++I) { 11686 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 11687 11688 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam 11689 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 11690 // candidate list. 11691 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) { 11692 break; 11693 } 11694 ++CandsShown; 11695 11696 if (Cand->Function) 11697 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(), 11698 /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false, DestAS); 11699 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 11700 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 11701 else { 11702 assert(Cand->Viable && 11703 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 11704 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 11705 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 11706 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 11707 // 11708 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 11709 // different ambiguities, though. 11710 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 11711 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 11712 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 11713 } 11714 11715 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 11716 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 11717 } 11718 } 11719 11720 if (I != E) 11721 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates, 11722 shouldDeferDiags(S, Args, OpLoc)) 11723 << int(E - I); 11724 } 11725 11726 static SourceLocation 11727 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) { 11728 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation() 11729 : SourceLocation(); 11730 } 11731 11732 namespace { 11733 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay { 11734 Sema &S; 11735 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 11736 11737 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L, 11738 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) { 11739 // Fast-path this check. 11740 if (L == R) 11741 return false; 11742 11743 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches... 11744 11745 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures. 11746 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 11747 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) < 11748 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 11749 11750 // Sort everything else by location. 11751 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 11752 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 11753 11754 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 11755 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) 11756 return false; 11757 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) 11758 return true; 11759 11760 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 11761 } 11762 }; 11763 } 11764 11765 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure. 11766 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad 11767 /// deductions. 11768 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S, 11769 bool ForTakingAddress) { 11770 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern 11771 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress); 11772 } 11773 11774 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 11775 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 11776 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 11777 } 11778 } 11779 11780 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() { 11781 destroyCandidates(); 11782 Candidates.clear(); 11783 } 11784 11785 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints 11786 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form 11787 /// the candidate set. 11788 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with 11789 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false. 11790 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 11791 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match). 11792 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers 11793 // and sort those. 11794 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands; 11795 Cands.reserve(size()); 11796 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 11797 if (Cand->Specialization) 11798 Cands.push_back(Cand); 11799 // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate. We do not, 11800 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate. 11801 } 11802 11803 llvm::sort(Cands, CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 11804 11805 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads() 11806 // for generalization purposes (?). 11807 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 11808 11809 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E; 11810 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 11811 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 11812 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I; 11813 11814 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam 11815 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 11816 // candidate list. 11817 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 11818 break; 11819 ++CandsShown; 11820 11821 assert(Cand->Specialization && 11822 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 11823 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress); 11824 } 11825 11826 if (I != E) 11827 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 11828 } 11829 11830 // [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return] 11831 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType 11832 // R (A) --> R(A) 11833 // R (*)(A) --> R (A) 11834 // R (&)(A) --> R (A) 11835 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A) 11836 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) { 11837 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType; 11838 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = 11839 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11840 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11841 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = 11842 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11843 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11844 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 11845 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 11846 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11847 Ret = 11848 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType(); 11849 return Ret; 11850 } 11851 11852 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc, 11853 bool Complain = true) { 11854 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 11855 S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain)) 11856 return true; 11857 11858 auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11859 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 11860 isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) && 11861 !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT)) 11862 return true; 11863 11864 return false; 11865 } 11866 11867 namespace { 11868 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution 11869 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters 11870 class AddressOfFunctionResolver { 11871 Sema& S; 11872 Expr* SourceExpr; 11873 const QualType& TargetType; 11874 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type 11875 11876 bool Complain; 11877 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair; 11878 ASTContext& Context; 11879 11880 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction; 11881 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction; 11882 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 11883 bool HasComplained; 11884 11885 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo; 11886 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr; 11887 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs; 11888 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 11889 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates; 11890 11891 public: 11892 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr, 11893 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain) 11894 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType), 11895 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()), 11896 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction( 11897 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()), 11898 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false), 11899 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false), 11900 HasComplained(false), 11901 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)), 11902 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression), 11903 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) { 11904 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType(); 11905 11906 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 11907 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr)) 11908 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() && 11909 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME)) 11910 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true; 11911 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11912 DeclAccessPair dap; 11913 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 11914 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) { 11915 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) 11916 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 11917 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found 11918 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the 11919 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with. 11920 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true; 11921 11922 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form. 11923 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions. 11924 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer) 11925 return; 11926 } 11927 11928 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn)); 11929 } 11930 return; 11931 } 11932 11933 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 11934 OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs); 11935 11936 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) { 11937 // C++ [over.over]p4: 11938 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 11939 if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) { 11940 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction) 11941 EliminateAllTemplateMatches(); 11942 else 11943 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate(); 11944 } 11945 } 11946 11947 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1) 11948 EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches(); 11949 } 11950 11951 bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; } 11952 11953 private: 11954 bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 11955 QualType Discard; 11956 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) || 11957 S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard); 11958 } 11959 11960 /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the 11961 /// desired type than B. 11962 bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) { 11963 // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it 11964 // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to 11965 // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match. 11966 return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) && 11967 (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) || 11968 compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better); 11969 } 11970 11971 /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate, 11972 /// false otherwise. 11973 bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() { 11974 // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best", 11975 // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best. 11976 auto Best = Matches.begin(); 11977 for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I) 11978 if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second)) 11979 Best = I; 11980 11981 const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second; 11982 auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn]( 11983 const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) { 11984 return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second); 11985 }; 11986 11987 // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best 11988 // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error 11989 if (!llvm::all_of(Matches, IsBestOrInferiorToBest)) 11990 return false; 11991 Matches[0] = *Best; 11992 Matches.resize(1); 11993 return true; 11994 } 11995 11996 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const { 11997 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType(); 11998 } 11999 12000 // [ToType] [Return] 12001 12002 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 12003 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 12004 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true 12005 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() { 12006 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType); 12007 } 12008 12009 // return true if any matching specializations were found 12010 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate, 12011 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 12012 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 12013 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 12014 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 12015 // static when converting to member pointer. 12016 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 12017 return false; 12018 } 12019 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 12020 return false; 12021 12022 // C++ [over.over]p2: 12023 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 12024 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 12025 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 12026 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 12027 // overloaded functions considered. 12028 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 12029 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 12030 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result 12031 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, 12032 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs, 12033 TargetFunctionType, Specialization, 12034 Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 12035 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 12036 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 12037 .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 12038 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 12039 return false; 12040 } 12041 12042 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or 12043 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS. 12044 // This function template specicalization works. 12045 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType( 12046 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()), 12047 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType))); 12048 12049 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization)) 12050 return false; 12051 12052 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization)); 12053 return true; 12054 } 12055 12056 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn, 12057 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 12058 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 12059 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 12060 // when converting to member pointer. 12061 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 12062 return false; 12063 } 12064 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 12065 return false; 12066 12067 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 12068 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) 12069 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) 12070 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl)) 12071 return false; 12072 if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) { 12073 const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 12074 if (TA && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 12075 return false; 12076 } 12077 12078 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction 12079 // now. 12080 if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), 12081 Complain)) { 12082 HasComplained |= Complain; 12083 return false; 12084 } 12085 12086 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl)) 12087 return false; 12088 12089 // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical. 12090 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 12091 candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) { 12092 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair( 12093 CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 12094 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 12095 return true; 12096 } 12097 } 12098 12099 return false; 12100 } 12101 12102 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() { 12103 bool Ret = false; 12104 12105 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 12106 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 12107 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 12108 return false; 12109 12110 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 12111 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 12112 I != E; ++I) { 12113 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 12114 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 12115 12116 // C++ [over.over]p3: 12117 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 12118 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 12119 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 12120 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 12121 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 12122 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 12123 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 12124 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair())) 12125 Ret = true; 12126 } 12127 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates. 12128 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 12129 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair())) 12130 Ret = true; 12131 } 12132 assert(Ret || Matches.empty()); 12133 return Ret; 12134 } 12135 12136 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() { 12137 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 12138 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 12139 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 12140 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 12141 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 12142 12143 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 12144 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 12145 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 12146 // best function template (if it exists). 12147 12148 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 12149 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 12150 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 12151 12152 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose 12153 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0. 12154 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized( 12155 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates, 12156 SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), S.PDiag(), 12157 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12158 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(), 12159 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 12160 << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template, 12161 Complain, TargetFunctionType); 12162 12163 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) { 12164 // Make it the first and only element 12165 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 12166 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 12167 Matches.resize(1); 12168 } else 12169 HasComplained |= Complain; 12170 } 12171 12172 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() { 12173 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 12174 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 12175 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 12176 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr) 12177 ++I; 12178 else { 12179 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 12180 Matches.resize(N); 12181 } 12182 } 12183 } 12184 12185 void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() { 12186 S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches); 12187 } 12188 12189 public: 12190 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const { 12191 assert(Matches.empty()); 12192 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 12193 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType 12194 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12195 if (FailedCandidates.empty()) 12196 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 12197 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12198 else { 12199 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose 12200 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates 12201 // normally. 12202 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 12203 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 12204 I != IEnd; ++I) 12205 if (FunctionDecl *Fun = 12206 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) 12207 if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun)) 12208 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, TargetFunctionType, 12209 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12210 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getBeginLoc()); 12211 } 12212 } 12213 12214 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 12215 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction && 12216 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer; 12217 } 12218 12219 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 12220 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 12221 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 12222 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 12223 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 12224 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12225 } 12226 12227 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 12228 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 12229 } 12230 12231 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 12232 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), 12233 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 12234 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12235 } 12236 12237 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const { 12238 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 12239 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType; 12240 } 12241 12242 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const { 12243 assert(Matches.size() > 1); 12244 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12245 << OvlExpr->getName() << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12246 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 12247 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12248 } 12249 12250 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); } 12251 12252 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); } 12253 12254 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const { 12255 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 12256 return Matches[0].second; 12257 } 12258 12259 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const { 12260 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 12261 return &Matches[0].first; 12262 } 12263 }; 12264 } 12265 12266 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 12267 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 12268 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 12269 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 12270 /// 12271 /// @code 12272 /// int f(double); 12273 /// int f(int); 12274 /// 12275 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 12276 /// @endcode 12277 /// 12278 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 12279 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 12280 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 12281 FunctionDecl * 12282 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, 12283 QualType TargetType, 12284 bool Complain, 12285 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult, 12286 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) { 12287 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12288 12289 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, 12290 Complain); 12291 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches(); 12292 FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr; 12293 bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained(); 12294 if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) { 12295 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 12296 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction(); 12297 else 12298 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound(); 12299 } 12300 else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain) 12301 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound(); 12302 else if (NumMatches == 1) { 12303 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl(); 12304 assert(Fn); 12305 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 12306 ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT); 12307 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair(); 12308 if (Complain) { 12309 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer()) 12310 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(); 12311 else 12312 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult); 12313 } 12314 } 12315 12316 if (pHadMultipleCandidates) 12317 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates(); 12318 return Fn; 12319 } 12320 12321 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 12322 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken. 12323 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null. 12324 /// 12325 /// This routine can only succeed if from all of the candidates in the overload 12326 /// set for SrcExpr that can have their addresses taken, there is one candidate 12327 /// that is more constrained than the rest. 12328 FunctionDecl * 12329 Sema::resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &Pair) { 12330 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E); 12331 OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression; 12332 bool IsResultAmbiguous = false; 12333 FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr; 12334 DeclAccessPair DAP; 12335 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 2> AmbiguousDecls; 12336 12337 auto CheckMoreConstrained = 12338 [&] (FunctionDecl *FD1, FunctionDecl *FD2) -> Optional<bool> { 12339 SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> AC1, AC2; 12340 FD1->getAssociatedConstraints(AC1); 12341 FD2->getAssociatedConstraints(AC2); 12342 bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2; 12343 if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD1, AC1, FD2, AC2, AtLeastAsConstrained1)) 12344 return None; 12345 if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD2, AC2, FD1, AC1, AtLeastAsConstrained2)) 12346 return None; 12347 if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 == AtLeastAsConstrained2) 12348 return None; 12349 return AtLeastAsConstrained1; 12350 }; 12351 12352 // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for 12353 // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks 12354 // enable_if/pass_object_size/... 12355 for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12356 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl()); 12357 if (!FD) 12358 return nullptr; 12359 12360 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 12361 continue; 12362 12363 // We have more than one result - see if it is more constrained than the 12364 // previous one. 12365 if (Result) { 12366 Optional<bool> MoreConstrainedThanPrevious = CheckMoreConstrained(FD, 12367 Result); 12368 if (!MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) { 12369 IsResultAmbiguous = true; 12370 AmbiguousDecls.push_back(FD); 12371 continue; 12372 } 12373 if (!*MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) 12374 continue; 12375 // FD is more constrained - replace Result with it. 12376 } 12377 IsResultAmbiguous = false; 12378 DAP = I.getPair(); 12379 Result = FD; 12380 } 12381 12382 if (IsResultAmbiguous) 12383 return nullptr; 12384 12385 if (Result) { 12386 SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> ResultAC; 12387 // We skipped over some ambiguous declarations which might be ambiguous with 12388 // the selected result. 12389 for (FunctionDecl *Skipped : AmbiguousDecls) 12390 if (!CheckMoreConstrained(Skipped, Result).hasValue()) 12391 return nullptr; 12392 Pair = DAP; 12393 } 12394 return Result; 12395 } 12396 12397 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded 12398 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate. This 12399 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if 12400 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay. 12401 /// 12402 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate fails. 12403 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true. 12404 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate( 12405 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) { 12406 Expr *E = SrcExpr.get(); 12407 assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload"); 12408 12409 DeclAccessPair DAP; 12410 FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(E, DAP); 12411 if (!Found || Found->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || 12412 Found->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) 12413 return false; 12414 12415 // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and 12416 // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check 12417 // for both. 12418 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc()); 12419 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP); 12420 Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found); 12421 if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType()) 12422 SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false); 12423 else 12424 SrcExpr = Fixed; 12425 return true; 12426 } 12427 12428 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 12429 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 12430 /// 12431 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 12432 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 12433 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 12434 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 12435 /// 12436 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is 12437 /// returned. 12438 FunctionDecl * 12439 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, 12440 bool Complain, 12441 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) { 12442 // C++ [over.over]p1: 12443 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 12444 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 12445 // C++ [over.over]p1: 12446 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 12447 // operator. 12448 12449 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 12450 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 12451 return nullptr; 12452 12453 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 12454 ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 12455 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc()); 12456 12457 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 12458 // whose type matches exactly. 12459 FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr; 12460 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(), 12461 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12462 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 12463 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 12464 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 12465 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 12466 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 12467 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 12468 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 12469 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 12470 12471 // C++ [over.over]p2: 12472 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 12473 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 12474 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 12475 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 12476 // overloaded functions considered. 12477 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 12478 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 12479 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 12480 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12481 Specialization, Info, 12482 /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 12483 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 12484 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info? 12485 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 12486 .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 12487 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 12488 continue; 12489 } 12490 12491 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?"); 12492 12493 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 12494 if (Matched) { 12495 if (Complain) { 12496 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12497 << ovl->getName(); 12498 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl); 12499 } 12500 return nullptr; 12501 } 12502 12503 Matched = Specialization; 12504 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair(); 12505 } 12506 12507 if (Matched && 12508 completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain)) 12509 return nullptr; 12510 12511 return Matched; 12512 } 12513 12514 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved 12515 // because it identifies a single function template specialization. 12516 // 12517 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true 12518 // 12519 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the 12520 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always 12521 // returns true if 'complain' is set. 12522 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 12523 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, 12524 bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining, 12525 QualType DestTypeForComplaining, 12526 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) { 12527 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12528 12529 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get()); 12530 12531 DeclAccessPair found; 12532 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression; 12533 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 12534 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) { 12535 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getBeginLoc())) { 12536 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12537 return true; 12538 } 12539 12540 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're 12541 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member. 12542 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which 12543 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this. 12544 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer && 12545 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) && 12546 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) { 12547 if (!complain) return false; 12548 12549 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(), 12550 diag::err_bound_member_function) 12551 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange(); 12552 12553 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of 12554 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression 12555 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type). 12556 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why 12557 // the static candidates were rejected. 12558 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12559 return true; 12560 } 12561 12562 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'. 12563 SingleFunctionExpression = 12564 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn); 12565 12566 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay. 12567 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) { 12568 SingleFunctionExpression = 12569 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get()); 12570 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) { 12571 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12572 return true; 12573 } 12574 } 12575 } 12576 12577 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) { 12578 if (complain) { 12579 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining) 12580 << ovl.Expression->getName() 12581 << DestTypeForComplaining 12582 << OpRangeForComplaining 12583 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(); 12584 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get()); 12585 12586 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12587 return true; 12588 } 12589 12590 return false; 12591 } 12592 12593 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression; 12594 return true; 12595 } 12596 12597 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set. 12598 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 12599 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 12600 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12601 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12602 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 12603 bool PartialOverloading, 12604 bool KnownValid) { 12605 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 12606 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 12607 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 12608 12609 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 12610 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 12611 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?"); 12612 return; 12613 } 12614 // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates. 12615 if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>())) 12616 return; 12617 12618 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 12619 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 12620 PartialOverloading); 12621 return; 12622 } 12623 12624 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 12625 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 12626 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 12627 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 12628 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 12629 PartialOverloading); 12630 return; 12631 } 12632 12633 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 12634 } 12635 12636 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 12637 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 12638 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12639 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12640 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 12641 bool PartialOverloading) { 12642 12643 #ifndef NDEBUG 12644 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 12645 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 12646 // 12647 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 12648 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 12649 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 12650 // 12651 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 12652 // 12653 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 12654 // using-declaration, or 12655 // 12656 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 12657 // template 12658 // 12659 // then Y is empty. 12660 12661 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 12662 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 12663 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12664 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 12665 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 12666 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 12667 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 12668 } 12669 } 12670 #endif 12671 12672 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 12673 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 12674 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 12675 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12676 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 12677 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 12678 } 12679 12680 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 12681 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 12682 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12683 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 12684 /*KnownValid*/ true); 12685 12686 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 12687 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(), 12688 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12689 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 12690 } 12691 12692 /// Add the call candidates from the given set of lookup results to the given 12693 /// overload set. Non-function lookup results are ignored. 12694 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates( 12695 LookupResult &R, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12696 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 12697 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 12698 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12699 CandidateSet, false, /*KnownValid*/ false); 12700 } 12701 12702 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into 12703 /// a different namespace. 12704 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) { 12705 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) { 12706 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New: 12707 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete: 12708 return false; 12709 12710 default: 12711 return true; 12712 } 12713 } 12714 12715 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a 12716 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template 12717 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not 12718 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup. 12719 /// 12720 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 12721 static bool DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup( 12722 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 12723 LookupResult &R, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK, 12724 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12725 CXXRecordDecl **FoundInClass = nullptr) { 12726 if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty()) 12727 return false; 12728 12729 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) { 12730 if (DC->isTransparentContext()) 12731 continue; 12732 12733 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 12734 12735 if (!R.empty()) { 12736 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12737 12738 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK); 12739 SemaRef.AddOverloadedCallCandidates(R, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12740 Candidates); 12741 12742 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12743 OverloadingResult OR = 12744 Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best); 12745 12746 if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 12747 // We either found non-function declarations or a best viable function 12748 // at class scope. A class-scope lookup result disables ADL. Don't 12749 // look past this, but let the caller know that we found something that 12750 // either is, or might be, usable in this class. 12751 if (FoundInClass) { 12752 *FoundInClass = RD; 12753 if (OR == OR_Success) { 12754 R.clear(); 12755 R.addDecl(Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(), Best->FoundDecl.getAccess()); 12756 R.resolveKind(); 12757 } 12758 } 12759 return false; 12760 } 12761 12762 if (OR != OR_Success) { 12763 // There wasn't a unique best function or function template. 12764 return false; 12765 } 12766 12767 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest 12768 // declaring the function there instead. 12769 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces; 12770 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses; 12771 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args, 12772 AssociatedNamespaces, 12773 AssociatedClasses); 12774 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces; 12775 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) { 12776 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace(); 12777 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator 12778 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(), 12779 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) { 12780 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'. 12781 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it)) 12782 continue; 12783 12784 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a 12785 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx. 12786 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it); 12787 if (NS && 12788 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos) 12789 continue; 12790 12791 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it); 12792 } 12793 } 12794 12795 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12796 << R.getLookupName(); 12797 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) { 12798 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12799 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12800 << R.getLookupName() << 0; 12801 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) { 12802 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12803 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12804 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin(); 12805 } else { 12806 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here, 12807 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce 12808 // a localized representation of a list of items. 12809 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12810 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12811 << R.getLookupName() << 2; 12812 } 12813 12814 // Try to recover by calling this function. 12815 return true; 12816 } 12817 12818 R.clear(); 12819 } 12820 12821 return false; 12822 } 12823 12824 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a 12825 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template 12826 /// was defined. 12827 /// 12828 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 12829 static bool 12830 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 12831 SourceLocation OpLoc, 12832 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 12833 DeclarationName OpName = 12834 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 12835 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName); 12836 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R, 12837 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 12838 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args); 12839 } 12840 12841 namespace { 12842 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII { 12843 Sema &SemaRef; 12844 public: 12845 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) { 12846 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false); 12847 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true; 12848 } 12849 12850 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() { 12851 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false; 12852 } 12853 }; 12854 12855 } 12856 12857 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 12858 /// 12859 /// This function will do one of three things: 12860 /// * Diagnose, recover, and return a recovery expression. 12861 /// * Diagnose, fail to recover, and return ExprError(). 12862 /// * Do not diagnose, do not recover, and return ExprResult(). The caller is 12863 /// expected to diagnose as appropriate. 12864 static ExprResult 12865 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12866 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12867 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12868 MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12869 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12870 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 12871 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call. 12872 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like 12873 // 12874 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {} 12875 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {} 12876 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr) 12877 return ExprResult(); 12878 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef); 12879 12880 CXXScopeSpec SS; 12881 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 12882 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(); 12883 12884 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 12885 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 12886 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12887 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 12888 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 12889 } 12890 12891 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 12892 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 12893 CXXRecordDecl *FoundInClass = nullptr; 12894 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, 12895 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal, 12896 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, &FoundInClass)) { 12897 // OK, diagnosed a two-phase lookup issue. 12898 } else if (EmptyLookup) { 12899 // Try to recover from an empty lookup with typo correction. 12900 R.clear(); 12901 NoTypoCorrectionCCC NoTypoValidator{}; 12902 FunctionCallFilterCCC FunctionCallValidator(SemaRef, Args.size(), 12903 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr, 12904 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn)); 12905 CorrectionCandidateCallback &Validator = 12906 AllowTypoCorrection 12907 ? static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(FunctionCallValidator) 12908 : static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(NoTypoValidator); 12909 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Validator, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12910 Args)) 12911 return ExprError(); 12912 } else if (FoundInClass && SemaRef.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 12913 // We found a usable declaration of the name in a dependent base of some 12914 // enclosing class. 12915 // FIXME: We should also explain why the candidates found by name lookup 12916 // were not viable. 12917 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseDependentMemberLookup(R)) 12918 return ExprError(); 12919 } else { 12920 // We had viable candidates and couldn't recover; let the caller diagnose 12921 // this. 12922 return ExprResult(); 12923 } 12924 12925 // If we get here, we should have issued a diagnostic and formed a recovery 12926 // lookup result. 12927 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 12928 12929 // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out. 12930 if (R.isAmbiguous()) { 12931 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12932 return ExprError(); 12933 } 12934 12935 // Build an implicit member access expression if appropriate. Just drop the 12936 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 12937 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 12938 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 12939 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, 12940 ExplicitTemplateArgs, S); 12941 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) 12942 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false, 12943 ExplicitTemplateArgs); 12944 else 12945 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 12946 12947 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 12948 return ExprError(); 12949 12950 auto CallE = 12951 SemaRef.BuildCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc, 12952 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), RParenLoc); 12953 if (CallE.isInvalid()) 12954 return ExprError(); 12955 // We now have recovered a callee. However, building a real call may lead to 12956 // incorrect secondary diagnostics if our recovery wasn't correct. 12957 // We keep the recovery behavior but suppress all following diagnostics by 12958 // using RecoveryExpr. We deliberately drop the return type of the recovery 12959 // function, and rely on clang's dependent mechanism to suppress following 12960 // diagnostics. 12961 return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(CallE.get()->getBeginLoc(), 12962 CallE.get()->getEndLoc(), {CallE.get()}); 12963 } 12964 12965 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from 12966 /// the given function. 12967 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set. 12968 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12969 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12970 MultiExprArg Args, 12971 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12972 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 12973 ExprResult *Result) { 12974 #ifndef NDEBUG 12975 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 12976 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 12977 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 12978 12979 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 12980 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 12981 FunctionDecl *F; 12982 if (ULE->decls_begin() != ULE->decls_end() && 12983 ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 12984 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 12985 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 12986 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin"); 12987 12988 // We don't perform ADL in C. 12989 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 12990 } 12991 #endif 12992 12993 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 12994 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) { 12995 *Result = ExprError(); 12996 return true; 12997 } 12998 12999 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 13000 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 13001 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet); 13002 13003 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 13004 CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() && 13005 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) { 13006 13007 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13008 if (CandidateSet->empty() || 13009 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best) == 13010 OR_No_Viable_Function) { 13011 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function 13012 // then create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name 13013 // lookup to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent 13014 // base classes. 13015 CallExpr *CE = 13016 CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, 13017 RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13018 CE->markDependentForPostponedNameLookup(); 13019 *Result = CE; 13020 return true; 13021 } 13022 } 13023 13024 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 13025 return false; 13026 13027 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 13028 return false; 13029 } 13030 13031 // Guess at what the return type for an unresolvable overload should be. 13032 static QualType chooseRecoveryType(OverloadCandidateSet &CS, 13033 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best) { 13034 llvm::Optional<QualType> Result; 13035 // Adjust Type after seeing a candidate. 13036 auto ConsiderCandidate = [&](const OverloadCandidate &Candidate) { 13037 if (!Candidate.Function) 13038 return; 13039 if (Candidate.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 13040 return; 13041 QualType T = Candidate.Function->getReturnType(); 13042 if (T.isNull()) 13043 return; 13044 if (!Result) 13045 Result = T; 13046 else if (Result != T) 13047 Result = QualType(); 13048 }; 13049 13050 // Look for an unambiguous type from a progressively larger subset. 13051 // e.g. if types disagree, but all *viable* overloads return int, choose int. 13052 // 13053 // First, consider only the best candidate. 13054 if (Best && *Best != CS.end()) 13055 ConsiderCandidate(**Best); 13056 // Next, consider only viable candidates. 13057 if (!Result) 13058 for (const auto &C : CS) 13059 if (C.Viable) 13060 ConsiderCandidate(C); 13061 // Finally, consider all candidates. 13062 if (!Result) 13063 for (const auto &C : CS) 13064 ConsiderCandidate(C); 13065 13066 if (!Result) 13067 return QualType(); 13068 auto Value = Result.getValue(); 13069 if (Value.isNull() || Value->isUndeducedType()) 13070 return QualType(); 13071 return Value; 13072 } 13073 13074 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns 13075 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits 13076 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError() 13077 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 13078 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 13079 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 13080 MultiExprArg Args, 13081 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 13082 Expr *ExecConfig, 13083 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 13084 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best, 13085 OverloadingResult OverloadResult, 13086 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 13087 switch (OverloadResult) { 13088 case OR_Success: { 13089 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 13090 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl); 13091 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc())) 13092 return ExprError(); 13093 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 13094 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 13095 ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false, 13096 (*Best)->IsADLCandidate); 13097 } 13098 13099 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 13100 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might 13101 // have meant to call. 13102 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 13103 Args, RParenLoc, 13104 CandidateSet->empty(), 13105 AllowTypoCorrection); 13106 if (Recovery.isInvalid() || Recovery.isUsable()) 13107 return Recovery; 13108 13109 // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we 13110 // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to 13111 // emit better ones. 13112 for (const Expr *Arg : Args) { 13113 if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType()) 13114 continue; 13115 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) { 13116 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 13117 if (FD && 13118 !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 13119 Arg->getExprLoc())) 13120 return ExprError(); 13121 } 13122 } 13123 13124 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 13125 PartialDiagnosticAt( 13126 Fn->getBeginLoc(), 13127 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 13128 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 13129 SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13130 break; 13131 } 13132 13133 case OR_Ambiguous: 13134 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 13135 PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 13136 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 13137 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 13138 SemaRef, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 13139 break; 13140 13141 case OR_Deleted: { 13142 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 13143 PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 13144 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 13145 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 13146 SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13147 13148 // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep 13149 // the call in the AST. 13150 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 13151 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 13152 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 13153 ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false, 13154 (*Best)->IsADLCandidate); 13155 } 13156 } 13157 13158 // Overload resolution failed, try to recover. 13159 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> SubExprs = {Fn}; 13160 SubExprs.append(Args.begin(), Args.end()); 13161 return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(Fn->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs, 13162 chooseRecoveryType(*CandidateSet, Best)); 13163 } 13164 13165 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S, 13166 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) { 13167 for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) { 13168 if (I->Viable && 13169 !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) { 13170 I->Viable = false; 13171 I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available; 13172 } 13173 } 13174 } 13175 13176 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn 13177 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 13178 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 13179 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 13180 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution. 13181 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError. 13182 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 13183 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 13184 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 13185 MultiExprArg Args, 13186 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 13187 Expr *ExecConfig, 13188 bool AllowTypoCorrection, 13189 bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) { 13190 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(), 13191 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 13192 ExprResult result; 13193 13194 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet, 13195 &result)) 13196 return result; 13197 13198 // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that 13199 // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable. 13200 if (CalleesAddressIsTaken) 13201 markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet); 13202 13203 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13204 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 13205 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best); 13206 13207 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 13208 ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, &Best, 13209 OverloadResult, AllowTypoCorrection); 13210 } 13211 13212 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 13213 return Functions.size() > 1 || 13214 (Functions.size() == 1 && 13215 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*Functions.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl())); 13216 } 13217 13218 ExprResult Sema::CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass, 13219 NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLoc, 13220 DeclarationNameInfo DNI, 13221 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13222 bool PerformADL) { 13223 return UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, NNSLoc, DNI, 13224 PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns), 13225 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 13226 } 13227 13228 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 13229 /// operator. 13230 /// 13231 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 13232 /// 13233 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 13234 /// 13235 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 13236 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 13237 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 13238 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 13239 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 13240 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 13241 /// 13242 /// \param Input The input argument. 13243 ExprResult 13244 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 13245 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13246 Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) { 13247 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13248 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 13249 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13250 // TODO: provide better source location info. 13251 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 13252 13253 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input)) 13254 return ExprError(); 13255 13256 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr }; 13257 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 13258 13259 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 13260 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 13261 // post-decrement. 13262 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 13263 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 13264 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 13265 SourceLocation()); 13266 NumArgs = 2; 13267 } 13268 13269 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs); 13270 13271 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 13272 if (Fns.empty()) 13273 return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy, 13274 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false, 13275 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13276 13277 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13278 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 13279 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns); 13280 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13281 return ExprError(); 13282 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), ArgsArray, 13283 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc, 13284 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13285 } 13286 13287 // Build an empty overload set. 13288 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 13289 13290 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 13291 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13292 13293 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13294 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13295 13296 // Add candidates from ADL. 13297 if (PerformADL) { 13298 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray, 13299 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr, 13300 CandidateSet); 13301 } 13302 13303 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13304 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13305 13306 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13307 13308 // Perform overload resolution. 13309 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13310 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13311 case OR_Success: { 13312 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13313 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13314 13315 if (FnDecl) { 13316 Expr *Base = nullptr; 13317 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13318 // operator. 13319 13320 // Convert the arguments. 13321 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13322 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 13323 13324 ExprResult InputRes = 13325 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13326 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13327 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 13328 return ExprError(); 13329 Base = Input = InputRes.get(); 13330 } else { 13331 // Convert the arguments. 13332 ExprResult InputInit 13333 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 13334 Context, 13335 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13336 SourceLocation(), 13337 Input); 13338 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 13339 return ExprError(); 13340 Input = InputInit.get(); 13341 } 13342 13343 // Build the actual expression node. 13344 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl, 13345 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, 13346 OpLoc); 13347 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13348 return ExprError(); 13349 13350 // Determine the result type. 13351 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13352 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13353 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13354 13355 Args[0] = Input; 13356 CallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 13357 Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 13358 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate); 13359 13360 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 13361 return ExprError(); 13362 13363 if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall, 13364 FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 13365 return ExprError(); 13366 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), FnDecl); 13367 } else { 13368 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13369 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13370 // operator node. 13371 ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion( 13372 Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing, 13373 CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13374 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 13375 return ExprError(); 13376 Input = InputRes.get(); 13377 break; 13378 } 13379 } 13380 13381 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13382 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 13383 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 13384 // defined too late to be candidates. 13385 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray)) 13386 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 13387 return ExprError(); 13388 13389 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 13390 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 13391 break; 13392 13393 case OR_Ambiguous: 13394 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13395 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, 13396 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 13397 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13398 << Input->getType() << Input->getSourceRange()), 13399 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, ArgsArray, 13400 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 13401 return ExprError(); 13402 13403 case OR_Deleted: 13404 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13405 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13406 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13407 << Input->getSourceRange()), 13408 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13409 OpLoc); 13410 return ExprError(); 13411 } 13412 13413 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 13414 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 13415 // build a built-in operation. 13416 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13417 } 13418 13419 /// Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator. 13420 void Sema::LookupOverloadedBinOp(OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 13421 OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 13422 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13423 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, bool PerformADL) { 13424 SourceLocation OpLoc = CandidateSet.getLocation(); 13425 13426 OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp = 13427 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().AllowRewrittenCandidates 13428 ? getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(Op) 13429 : OO_None; 13430 13431 // Add the candidates from the given function set. This also adds the 13432 // rewritten candidates using these functions if necessary. 13433 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet); 13434 13435 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13436 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13437 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Op)) 13438 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet, 13439 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 13440 13441 // In C++20, also add any rewritten member candidates. 13442 if (ExtraOp) { 13443 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13444 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(ExtraOp)) 13445 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, 13446 CandidateSet, 13447 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 13448 } 13449 13450 // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not 13451 // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->, 13452 // which don't get here). 13453 if (Op != OO_Equal && PerformADL) { 13454 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13455 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args, 13456 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 13457 CandidateSet); 13458 if (ExtraOp) { 13459 DeclarationName ExtraOpName = 13460 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(ExtraOp); 13461 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ExtraOpName, OpLoc, Args, 13462 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 13463 CandidateSet); 13464 } 13465 } 13466 13467 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13468 // 13469 // FIXME: We don't add any rewritten candidates here. This is strictly 13470 // incorrect; a builtin candidate could be hidden by a non-viable candidate, 13471 // resulting in our selecting a rewritten builtin candidate. For example: 13472 // 13473 // enum class E { e }; 13474 // bool operator!=(E, E) requires false; 13475 // bool k = E::e != E::e; 13476 // 13477 // ... should select the rewritten builtin candidate 'operator==(E, E)'. But 13478 // it seems unreasonable to consider rewritten builtin candidates. A core 13479 // issue has been filed proposing to removed this requirement. 13480 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13481 } 13482 13483 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 13484 /// operator. 13485 /// 13486 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 13487 /// 13488 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 13489 /// 13490 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 13491 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 13492 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 13493 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 13494 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 13495 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 13496 /// 13497 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 13498 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 13499 /// \param PerformADL Whether to consider operator candidates found by ADL. 13500 /// \param AllowRewrittenCandidates Whether to consider candidates found by 13501 /// C++20 operator rewrites. 13502 /// \param DefaultedFn If we are synthesizing a defaulted operator function, 13503 /// the function in question. Such a function is never a candidate in 13504 /// our overload resolution. This also enables synthesizing a three-way 13505 /// comparison from < and == as described in C++20 [class.spaceship]p1. 13506 ExprResult Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 13507 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 13508 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, 13509 Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL, 13510 bool AllowRewrittenCandidates, 13511 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) { 13512 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 13513 LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 13514 13515 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 13516 AllowRewrittenCandidates = false; 13517 13518 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13519 13520 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 13521 // expression. 13522 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 13523 if (Fns.empty()) { 13524 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 13525 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 13526 if (BinaryOperator::isCompoundAssignmentOp(Opc)) 13527 return CompoundAssignOperator::Create( 13528 Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, 13529 OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Context.DependentTy, 13530 Context.DependentTy); 13531 return BinaryOperator::Create(Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, 13532 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 13533 OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13534 } 13535 13536 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 13537 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13538 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 13539 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13540 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 13541 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 13542 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns, PerformADL); 13543 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13544 return ExprError(); 13545 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), Args, 13546 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc, 13547 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13548 } 13549 13550 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS. 13551 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 13552 return ExprError(); 13553 13554 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should 13555 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS. 13556 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty); 13557 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 13558 return ExprError(); 13559 13560 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 13561 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 13562 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 13563 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 13564 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 13565 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 13566 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13567 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13568 13569 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 13570 // create a built-in binary operator. 13571 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 13572 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13573 13574 // Build the overload set. 13575 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 13576 OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 13577 OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo(Op, AllowRewrittenCandidates)); 13578 if (DefaultedFn) 13579 CandidateSet.exclude(DefaultedFn); 13580 LookupOverloadedBinOp(CandidateSet, Op, Fns, Args, PerformADL); 13581 13582 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13583 13584 // Perform overload resolution. 13585 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13586 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13587 case OR_Success: { 13588 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13589 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13590 13591 bool IsReversed = Best->isReversed(); 13592 if (IsReversed) 13593 std::swap(Args[0], Args[1]); 13594 13595 if (FnDecl) { 13596 Expr *Base = nullptr; 13597 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13598 // operator. 13599 13600 OverloadedOperatorKind ChosenOp = 13601 FnDecl->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator(); 13602 13603 // C++2a [over.match.oper]p9: 13604 // If a rewritten operator== candidate is selected by overload 13605 // resolution for an operator@, its return type shall be cv bool 13606 if (Best->RewriteKind && ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && 13607 !FnDecl->getReturnType()->isBooleanType()) { 13608 bool IsExtension = 13609 FnDecl->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 13610 Diag(OpLoc, IsExtension ? diag::ext_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool 13611 : diag::err_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool) 13612 << FnDecl->getReturnType() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13613 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13614 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 13615 if (!IsExtension) 13616 return ExprError(); 13617 } 13618 13619 if (AllowRewrittenCandidates && !IsReversed && 13620 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isReversible()) { 13621 // We could have reversed this operator, but didn't. Check if some 13622 // reversed form was a viable candidate, and if so, if it had a 13623 // better conversion for either parameter. If so, this call is 13624 // formally ambiguous, and allowing it is an extension. 13625 llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl*, 4> AmbiguousWith; 13626 for (OverloadCandidate &Cand : CandidateSet) { 13627 if (Cand.Viable && Cand.Function && Cand.isReversed() && 13628 haveSameParameterTypes(Context, Cand.Function, FnDecl, 2)) { 13629 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 13630 if (CompareImplicitConversionSequences( 13631 *this, OpLoc, Cand.Conversions[ArgIdx], 13632 Best->Conversions[ArgIdx]) == 13633 ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) { 13634 AmbiguousWith.push_back(Cand.Function); 13635 break; 13636 } 13637 } 13638 } 13639 } 13640 13641 if (!AmbiguousWith.empty()) { 13642 bool AmbiguousWithSelf = 13643 AmbiguousWith.size() == 1 && 13644 declaresSameEntity(AmbiguousWith.front(), FnDecl); 13645 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed) 13646 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13647 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() << AmbiguousWithSelf 13648 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13649 if (AmbiguousWithSelf) { 13650 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), 13651 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_self); 13652 } else { 13653 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), 13654 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_selected_candidate); 13655 for (auto *F : AmbiguousWith) 13656 Diag(F->getLocation(), 13657 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_candidate); 13658 } 13659 } 13660 } 13661 13662 // Convert the arguments. 13663 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13664 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 13665 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 13666 13667 ExprResult Arg1 = 13668 PerformCopyInitialization( 13669 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13670 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13671 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 13672 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 13673 return ExprError(); 13674 13675 ExprResult Arg0 = 13676 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13677 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13678 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13679 return ExprError(); 13680 Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 13681 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 13682 } else { 13683 // Convert the arguments. 13684 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization( 13685 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13686 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13687 SourceLocation(), Args[0]); 13688 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13689 return ExprError(); 13690 13691 ExprResult Arg1 = 13692 PerformCopyInitialization( 13693 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13694 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 13695 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 13696 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 13697 return ExprError(); 13698 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 13699 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 13700 } 13701 13702 // Build the actual expression node. 13703 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 13704 Best->FoundDecl, Base, 13705 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 13706 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13707 return ExprError(); 13708 13709 // Determine the result type. 13710 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13711 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13712 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13713 13714 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 13715 Context, ChosenOp, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 13716 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate); 13717 13718 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 13719 FnDecl)) 13720 return ExprError(); 13721 13722 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2); 13723 const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr; 13724 // Cut off the implicit 'this'. 13725 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13726 ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0]; 13727 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1); 13728 } 13729 13730 // Check for a self move. 13731 if (Op == OO_Equal) 13732 DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc); 13733 13734 checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray, 13735 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(), 13736 VariadicDoesNotApply); 13737 13738 ExprResult R = MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13739 if (R.isInvalid()) 13740 return ExprError(); 13741 13742 R = CheckForImmediateInvocation(R, FnDecl); 13743 if (R.isInvalid()) 13744 return ExprError(); 13745 13746 // For a rewritten candidate, we've already reversed the arguments 13747 // if needed. Perform the rest of the rewrite now. 13748 if ((Best->RewriteKind & CRK_DifferentOperator) || 13749 (Op == OO_Spaceship && IsReversed)) { 13750 if (Op == OO_ExclaimEqual) { 13751 assert(ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && "unexpected operator name"); 13752 R = CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, UO_LNot, R.get()); 13753 } else { 13754 assert(ChosenOp == OO_Spaceship && "unexpected operator name"); 13755 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 13756 Expr *ZeroLiteral = 13757 IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, OpLoc); 13758 13759 Sema::CodeSynthesisContext Ctx; 13760 Ctx.Kind = Sema::CodeSynthesisContext::RewritingOperatorAsSpaceship; 13761 Ctx.Entity = FnDecl; 13762 pushCodeSynthesisContext(Ctx); 13763 13764 R = CreateOverloadedBinOp( 13765 OpLoc, Opc, Fns, IsReversed ? ZeroLiteral : R.get(), 13766 IsReversed ? R.get() : ZeroLiteral, PerformADL, 13767 /*AllowRewrittenCandidates=*/false); 13768 13769 popCodeSynthesisContext(); 13770 } 13771 if (R.isInvalid()) 13772 return ExprError(); 13773 } else { 13774 assert(ChosenOp == Op && "unexpected operator name"); 13775 } 13776 13777 // Make a note in the AST if we did any rewriting. 13778 if (Best->RewriteKind != CRK_None) 13779 R = new (Context) CXXRewrittenBinaryOperator(R.get(), IsReversed); 13780 13781 return R; 13782 } else { 13783 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13784 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13785 // operator node. 13786 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13787 Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], 13788 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13789 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 13790 return ExprError(); 13791 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 13792 13793 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13794 Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1], 13795 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13796 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 13797 return ExprError(); 13798 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 13799 break; 13800 } 13801 } 13802 13803 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 13804 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 13805 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 13806 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 13807 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 13808 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 13809 break; 13810 13811 // When defaulting an 'operator<=>', we can try to synthesize a three-way 13812 // compare result using '==' and '<'. 13813 if (DefaultedFn && Opc == BO_Cmp) { 13814 ExprResult E = BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(OpLoc, Fns, Args[0], 13815 Args[1], DefaultedFn); 13816 if (E.isInvalid() || E.isUsable()) 13817 return E; 13818 } 13819 13820 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment 13821 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that 13822 // no overloaded assignment operator found 13823 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 13824 StringRef OpcStr = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 13825 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 13826 Args, OpLoc); 13827 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 13828 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 13829 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 13830 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13831 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13832 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) { 13833 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete) 13834 << Args[0]->getType() 13835 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13836 } 13837 } else { 13838 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 13839 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 13840 // defined too late to be candidates. 13841 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args)) 13842 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 13843 return ExprError(); 13844 13845 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 13846 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 13847 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13848 } 13849 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 13850 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 13851 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Args, Cands, OpcStr, OpLoc); 13852 return Result; 13853 } 13854 13855 case OR_Ambiguous: 13856 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13857 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 13858 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13859 << Args[0]->getType() 13860 << Args[1]->getType() 13861 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13862 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13863 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13864 OpLoc); 13865 return ExprError(); 13866 13867 case OR_Deleted: 13868 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) { 13869 FunctionDecl *DeletedFD = Best->Function; 13870 DefaultedFunctionKind DFK = getDefaultedFunctionKind(DeletedFD); 13871 if (DFK.isSpecialMember()) { 13872 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper) 13873 << Args[0]->getType() << DFK.asSpecialMember(); 13874 } else { 13875 assert(DFK.isComparison()); 13876 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_comparison) 13877 << Args[0]->getType() << DeletedFD; 13878 } 13879 13880 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just 13881 // explain why it's deleted. 13882 NoteDeletedFunction(DeletedFD); 13883 return ExprError(); 13884 } 13885 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13886 PartialDiagnosticAt( 13887 OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13888 << getOperatorSpelling(Best->Function->getDeclName() 13889 .getCXXOverloadedOperator()) 13890 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13891 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13892 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13893 OpLoc); 13894 return ExprError(); 13895 } 13896 13897 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 13898 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13899 } 13900 13901 ExprResult Sema::BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison( 13902 SourceLocation OpLoc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, 13903 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) { 13904 const ComparisonCategoryInfo *Info = 13905 Context.CompCategories.lookupInfoForType(DefaultedFn->getReturnType()); 13906 // If we're not producing a known comparison category type, we can't 13907 // synthesize a three-way comparison. Let the caller diagnose this. 13908 if (!Info) 13909 return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr); 13910 13911 // If we ever want to perform this synthesis more generally, we will need to 13912 // apply the temporary materialization conversion to the operands. 13913 assert(LHS->isGLValue() && RHS->isGLValue() && 13914 "cannot use prvalue expressions more than once"); 13915 Expr *OrigLHS = LHS; 13916 Expr *OrigRHS = RHS; 13917 13918 // Replace the LHS and RHS with OpaqueValueExprs; we're going to refer to 13919 // each of them multiple times below. 13920 LHS = new (Context) 13921 OpaqueValueExpr(LHS->getExprLoc(), LHS->getType(), LHS->getValueKind(), 13922 LHS->getObjectKind(), LHS); 13923 RHS = new (Context) 13924 OpaqueValueExpr(RHS->getExprLoc(), RHS->getType(), RHS->getValueKind(), 13925 RHS->getObjectKind(), RHS); 13926 13927 ExprResult Eq = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_EQ, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, true, 13928 DefaultedFn); 13929 if (Eq.isInvalid()) 13930 return ExprError(); 13931 13932 ExprResult Less = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, 13933 true, DefaultedFn); 13934 if (Less.isInvalid()) 13935 return ExprError(); 13936 13937 ExprResult Greater; 13938 if (Info->isPartial()) { 13939 Greater = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, RHS, LHS, true, true, 13940 DefaultedFn); 13941 if (Greater.isInvalid()) 13942 return ExprError(); 13943 } 13944 13945 // Form the list of comparisons we're going to perform. 13946 struct Comparison { 13947 ExprResult Cmp; 13948 ComparisonCategoryResult Result; 13949 } Comparisons[4] = 13950 { {Eq, Info->isStrong() ? ComparisonCategoryResult::Equal 13951 : ComparisonCategoryResult::Equivalent}, 13952 {Less, ComparisonCategoryResult::Less}, 13953 {Greater, ComparisonCategoryResult::Greater}, 13954 {ExprResult(), ComparisonCategoryResult::Unordered}, 13955 }; 13956 13957 int I = Info->isPartial() ? 3 : 2; 13958 13959 // Combine the comparisons with suitable conditional expressions. 13960 ExprResult Result; 13961 for (; I >= 0; --I) { 13962 // Build a reference to the comparison category constant. 13963 auto *VI = Info->lookupValueInfo(Comparisons[I].Result); 13964 // FIXME: Missing a constant for a comparison category. Diagnose this? 13965 if (!VI) 13966 return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr); 13967 ExprResult ThisResult = 13968 BuildDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(), VI->VD); 13969 if (ThisResult.isInvalid()) 13970 return ExprError(); 13971 13972 // Build a conditional unless this is the final case. 13973 if (Result.get()) { 13974 Result = ActOnConditionalOp(OpLoc, OpLoc, Comparisons[I].Cmp.get(), 13975 ThisResult.get(), Result.get()); 13976 if (Result.isInvalid()) 13977 return ExprError(); 13978 } else { 13979 Result = ThisResult; 13980 } 13981 } 13982 13983 // Build a PseudoObjectExpr to model the rewriting of an <=> operator, and to 13984 // bind the OpaqueValueExprs before they're (repeatedly) used. 13985 Expr *SyntacticForm = BinaryOperator::Create( 13986 Context, OrigLHS, OrigRHS, BO_Cmp, Result.get()->getType(), 13987 Result.get()->getValueKind(), Result.get()->getObjectKind(), OpLoc, 13988 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13989 Expr *SemanticForm[] = {LHS, RHS, Result.get()}; 13990 return PseudoObjectExpr::Create(Context, SyntacticForm, SemanticForm, 2); 13991 } 13992 13993 ExprResult 13994 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 13995 SourceLocation RLoc, 13996 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 13997 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 13998 DeclarationName OpName = 13999 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 14000 14001 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 14002 // expression. 14003 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 14004 14005 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 14006 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 14007 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 14008 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 14009 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 14010 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>()); 14011 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 14012 return ExprError(); 14013 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 14014 14015 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn.get(), Args, 14016 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, 14017 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14018 } 14019 14020 // Handle placeholders on both operands. 14021 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 14022 return ExprError(); 14023 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 14024 return ExprError(); 14025 14026 // Build an empty overload set. 14027 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14028 14029 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 14030 14031 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 14032 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 14033 14034 // Add builtin operator candidates. 14035 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 14036 14037 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14038 14039 // Perform overload resolution. 14040 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14041 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 14042 case OR_Success: { 14043 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 14044 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 14045 14046 if (FnDecl) { 14047 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 14048 // operator. 14049 14050 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 14051 14052 // Convert the arguments. 14053 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 14054 ExprResult Arg0 = 14055 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14056 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14057 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 14058 return ExprError(); 14059 Args[0] = Arg0.get(); 14060 14061 // Convert the arguments. 14062 ExprResult InputInit 14063 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 14064 Context, 14065 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 14066 SourceLocation(), 14067 Args[1]); 14068 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 14069 return ExprError(); 14070 14071 Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 14072 14073 // Build the actual expression node. 14074 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc); 14075 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 14076 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 14077 Best->FoundDecl, 14078 Base, 14079 HadMultipleCandidates, 14080 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 14081 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 14082 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 14083 return ExprError(); 14084 14085 // Determine the result type 14086 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 14087 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14088 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14089 14090 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 14091 Context, OO_Subscript, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, RLoc, 14092 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14093 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 14094 return ExprError(); 14095 14096 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 14097 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 14098 return ExprError(); 14099 14100 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 14101 } else { 14102 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 14103 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 14104 // operator node. 14105 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion( 14106 Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], 14107 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 14108 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 14109 return ExprError(); 14110 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 14111 14112 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion( 14113 Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1], 14114 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 14115 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 14116 return ExprError(); 14117 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 14118 14119 break; 14120 } 14121 } 14122 14123 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14124 PartialDiagnostic PD = CandidateSet.empty() 14125 ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 14126 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 14127 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange()) 14128 : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 14129 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 14130 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()); 14131 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PD), *this, 14132 OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 14133 return ExprError(); 14134 } 14135 14136 case OR_Ambiguous: 14137 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14138 PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 14139 << "[]" << Args[0]->getType() 14140 << Args[1]->getType() 14141 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 14142 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 14143 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 14144 return ExprError(); 14145 14146 case OR_Deleted: 14147 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14148 PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 14149 << "[]" << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 14150 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 14151 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 14152 return ExprError(); 14153 } 14154 14155 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 14156 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 14157 } 14158 14159 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 14160 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 14161 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 14162 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object 14163 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 14164 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded 14165 /// member function. 14166 ExprResult Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 14167 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 14168 MultiExprArg Args, 14169 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 14170 bool AllowRecovery) { 14171 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy || 14172 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 14173 14174 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 14175 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 14176 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 14177 14178 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function. 14179 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14180 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy); 14181 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI); 14182 14183 QualType fnType = 14184 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 14185 14186 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14187 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context); 14188 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType()); 14189 14190 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the 14191 // member function we're calling. 14192 Qualifiers funcQuals = proto->getMethodQuals(); 14193 14194 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType(); 14195 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) 14196 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 14197 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers(); 14198 14199 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals; 14200 difference.removeObjCGCAttr(); 14201 difference.removeAddressSpace(); 14202 if (difference) { 14203 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString(); 14204 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals) 14205 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType() 14206 << qualsString 14207 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2); 14208 } 14209 14210 CXXMemberCallExpr *call = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create( 14211 Context, MemExprE, Args, resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc, 14212 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), proto->getNumParams()); 14213 14214 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(), 14215 call, nullptr)) 14216 return ExprError(); 14217 14218 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc)) 14219 return ExprError(); 14220 14221 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto)) 14222 return ExprError(); 14223 14224 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call); 14225 } 14226 14227 // We only try to build a recovery expr at this level if we can preserve 14228 // the return type, otherwise we return ExprError() and let the caller 14229 // recover. 14230 auto BuildRecoveryExpr = [&](QualType Type) { 14231 if (!AllowRecovery) 14232 return ExprError(); 14233 std::vector<Expr *> SubExprs = {MemExprE}; 14234 llvm::for_each(Args, [&SubExprs](Expr *E) { SubExprs.push_back(E); }); 14235 return CreateRecoveryExpr(MemExprE->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs, 14236 Type); 14237 }; 14238 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) 14239 return CallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, 14240 RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14241 14242 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 14243 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 14244 return ExprError(); 14245 14246 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 14247 CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr; 14248 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public); 14249 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr; 14250 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14251 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 14252 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 14253 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 14254 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 14255 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14256 } else { 14257 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 14258 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 14259 14260 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 14261 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification 14262 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue() 14263 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context); 14264 14265 // Add overload candidates 14266 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14267 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14268 14269 // FIXME: avoid copy. 14270 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 14271 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 14272 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 14273 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 14274 } 14275 14276 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 14277 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 14278 14279 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 14280 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 14281 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 14282 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 14283 14284 14285 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls. 14286 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 14287 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, 14288 CandidateSet, 14289 /*SuppressUserConversions*/ false); 14290 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 14291 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 14292 // non-template member function. 14293 if (TemplateArgs) 14294 continue; 14295 14296 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 14297 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 14298 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 14299 } else { 14300 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 14301 cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC, 14302 TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 14303 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 14304 } 14305 } 14306 14307 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 14308 14309 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14310 14311 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14312 bool Succeeded = false; 14313 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getBeginLoc(), 14314 Best)) { 14315 case OR_Success: 14316 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14317 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 14318 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 14319 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 14320 break; 14321 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template 14322 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 14323 // called on both. 14324 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 14325 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 14326 // being used. 14327 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() && 14328 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 14329 break; 14330 Succeeded = true; 14331 break; 14332 14333 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 14334 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14335 PartialDiagnosticAt( 14336 UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14337 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 14338 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14339 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14340 break; 14341 case OR_Ambiguous: 14342 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14343 PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14344 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 14345 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14346 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14347 break; 14348 case OR_Deleted: 14349 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14350 PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14351 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 14352 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14353 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14354 break; 14355 } 14356 // Overload resolution fails, try to recover. 14357 if (!Succeeded) 14358 return BuildRecoveryExpr(chooseRecoveryType(CandidateSet, &Best)); 14359 14360 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 14361 14362 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 14363 // non-member call based on that function. 14364 if (Method->isStatic()) { 14365 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args, 14366 RParenLoc); 14367 } 14368 14369 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 14370 } 14371 14372 QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType(); 14373 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 14374 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14375 14376 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 14377 const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14378 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create( 14379 Context, MemExprE, Args, ResultType, VK, RParenLoc, 14380 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Proto->getNumParams()); 14381 14382 // Check for a valid return type. 14383 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14384 TheCall, Method)) 14385 return BuildRecoveryExpr(ResultType); 14386 14387 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 14388 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 14389 // it was done at lookup. 14390 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 14391 ExprResult ObjectArg = 14392 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier, 14393 FoundDecl, Method); 14394 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid()) 14395 return ExprError(); 14396 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get()); 14397 } 14398 14399 // Convert the rest of the arguments 14400 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, 14401 RParenLoc)) 14402 return BuildRecoveryExpr(ResultType); 14403 14404 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 14405 14406 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 14407 return ExprError(); 14408 14409 // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading 14410 // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do 14411 // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors. 14412 if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14413 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = 14414 CheckEnableIf(Method, LParenLoc, Args, true)) { 14415 Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(), 14416 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 14417 << Method << Method->getSourceRange(); 14418 Diag(Method->getLocation(), 14419 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 14420 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 14421 return ExprError(); 14422 } 14423 } 14424 14425 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) || 14426 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) && 14427 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) { 14428 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl(); 14429 14430 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) && 14431 MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 14432 Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), 14433 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor) 14434 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext) 14435 << MD->getParent(); 14436 14437 Diag(MD->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName(); 14438 if (getLangOpts().AppleKext) 14439 Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext) 14440 << MD->getParent() << MD->getDeclName(); 14441 } 14442 } 14443 14444 if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD = 14445 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) { 14446 // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode. 14447 bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext; 14448 CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), /*IsDelete=*/false, 14449 CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true, 14450 MemExpr->getMemberLoc()); 14451 } 14452 14453 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), 14454 TheCall->getMethodDecl()); 14455 } 14456 14457 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 14458 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 14459 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 14460 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 14461 ExprResult 14462 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj, 14463 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 14464 MultiExprArg Args, 14465 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 14466 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj)) 14467 return ExprError(); 14468 ExprResult Object = Obj; 14469 14470 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 14471 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 14472 return ExprError(); 14473 14474 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && 14475 "Requires object type argument"); 14476 14477 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 14478 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 14479 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 14480 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 14481 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 14482 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 14483 // (E).operator(). 14484 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc, 14485 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14486 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 14487 14488 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(), 14489 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get())) 14490 return true; 14491 14492 const auto *Record = Object.get()->getType()->castAs<RecordType>(); 14493 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14494 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 14495 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 14496 14497 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 14498 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 14499 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(), 14500 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet, 14501 /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false); 14502 } 14503 14504 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 14505 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function 14506 // declared in T of the form 14507 // 14508 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 14509 // 14510 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 14511 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 14512 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 14513 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 14514 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 14515 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 14516 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 14517 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 14518 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 14519 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 14520 // within T by another intervening declaration. 14521 const auto &Conversions = 14522 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 14523 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 14524 NamedDecl *D = *I; 14525 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 14526 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 14527 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 14528 14529 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 14530 // surrogates. 14531 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 14532 continue; 14533 14534 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 14535 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) { 14536 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 14537 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 14538 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 14539 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 14540 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 14541 14542 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14543 { 14544 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 14545 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet); 14546 } 14547 } 14548 } 14549 14550 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14551 14552 // Perform overload resolution. 14553 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14554 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14555 Best)) { 14556 case OR_Success: 14557 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 14558 // below. 14559 break; 14560 14561 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14562 PartialDiagnostic PD = 14563 CandidateSet.empty() 14564 ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 14565 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1 14566 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()) 14567 : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 14568 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange()); 14569 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14570 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), PD), *this, 14571 OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14572 break; 14573 } 14574 case OR_Ambiguous: 14575 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14576 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14577 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 14578 << Object.get()->getType() 14579 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()), 14580 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14581 break; 14582 14583 case OR_Deleted: 14584 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14585 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14586 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 14587 << Object.get()->getType() 14588 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()), 14589 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14590 break; 14591 } 14592 14593 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 14594 return true; 14595 14596 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14597 14598 if (Best->Function == nullptr) { 14599 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 14600 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 14601 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 14602 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 14603 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 14604 14605 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, 14606 Best->FoundDecl); 14607 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc)) 14608 return ExprError(); 14609 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() && 14610 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!"); 14611 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 14612 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 14613 // on the object argument, then let BuildCallExpr finish the job. 14614 14615 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 14616 // and then call it. 14617 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, 14618 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates); 14619 if (Call.isInvalid()) 14620 return ExprError(); 14621 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 14622 Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create( 14623 Context, Call.get()->getType(), CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(), 14624 nullptr, VK_RValue, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14625 14626 return BuildCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc); 14627 } 14628 14629 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 14630 14631 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 14632 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 14633 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 14634 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14635 14636 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration. 14637 if (Method->isInvalidDecl()) 14638 return ExprError(); 14639 14640 const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14641 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 14642 14643 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo( 14644 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc); 14645 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc)); 14646 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 14647 Obj, HadMultipleCandidates, 14648 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 14649 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 14650 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 14651 return true; 14652 14653 // The number of argument slots to allocate in the call. If we have default 14654 // arguments we need to allocate space for them as well. We additionally 14655 // need one more slot for the object parameter. 14656 unsigned NumArgsSlots = 1 + std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams); 14657 14658 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object 14659 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list). 14660 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(NumArgsSlots); 14661 14662 bool IsError = false; 14663 14664 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 14665 ExprResult ObjRes = 14666 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14667 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14668 if (ObjRes.isInvalid()) 14669 IsError = true; 14670 else 14671 Object = ObjRes; 14672 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get(); 14673 14674 // Check the argument types. 14675 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) { 14676 Expr *Arg; 14677 if (i < Args.size()) { 14678 Arg = Args[i]; 14679 14680 // Pass the argument. 14681 14682 ExprResult InputInit 14683 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 14684 Context, 14685 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 14686 SourceLocation(), Arg); 14687 14688 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 14689 Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 14690 } else { 14691 ExprResult DefArg 14692 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 14693 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 14694 IsError = true; 14695 break; 14696 } 14697 14698 Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>(); 14699 } 14700 14701 MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg; 14702 } 14703 14704 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 14705 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 14706 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 14707 for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) { 14708 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 14709 nullptr); 14710 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid(); 14711 MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg.get(); 14712 } 14713 } 14714 14715 if (IsError) 14716 return true; 14717 14718 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 14719 14720 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly owned. 14721 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 14722 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14723 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14724 14725 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 14726 Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, 14727 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14728 14729 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method)) 14730 return true; 14731 14732 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 14733 return true; 14734 14735 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), Method); 14736 } 14737 14738 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 14739 /// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 14740 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 14741 ExprResult 14742 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, 14743 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) { 14744 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && 14745 "left-hand side must have class type"); 14746 14747 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base)) 14748 return ExprError(); 14749 14750 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 14751 14752 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 14753 // 14754 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 14755 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 14756 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 14757 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 14758 DeclarationName OpName = 14759 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 14760 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14761 14762 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 14763 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base)) 14764 return ExprError(); 14765 14766 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14767 LookupQualifiedName(R, Base->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 14768 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 14769 14770 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 14771 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 14772 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context), 14773 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false); 14774 } 14775 14776 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14777 14778 // Perform overload resolution. 14779 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14780 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 14781 case OR_Success: 14782 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 14783 break; 14784 14785 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14786 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 14787 if (CandidateSet.empty()) { 14788 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 14789 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) { 14790 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a 14791 // diagnostic, as requested. 14792 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true; 14793 return ExprError(); 14794 } 14795 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 14796 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange(); 14797 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) { 14798 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion) 14799 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "."); 14800 } 14801 } else 14802 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 14803 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 14804 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Base, Cands); 14805 return ExprError(); 14806 } 14807 case OR_Ambiguous: 14808 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14809 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 14810 << "->" << Base->getType() 14811 << Base->getSourceRange()), 14812 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Base); 14813 return ExprError(); 14814 14815 case OR_Deleted: 14816 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14817 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 14818 << "->" << Base->getSourceRange()), 14819 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 14820 return ExprError(); 14821 } 14822 14823 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 14824 14825 // Convert the object parameter. 14826 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14827 ExprResult BaseResult = 14828 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14829 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14830 if (BaseResult.isInvalid()) 14831 return ExprError(); 14832 Base = BaseResult.get(); 14833 14834 // Build the operator call. 14835 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 14836 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 14837 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 14838 return ExprError(); 14839 14840 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 14841 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14842 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14843 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 14844 CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), Base, 14845 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14846 14847 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method)) 14848 return ExprError(); 14849 14850 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 14851 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 14852 return ExprError(); 14853 14854 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 14855 } 14856 14857 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to 14858 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results. 14859 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, 14860 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, 14861 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 14862 SourceLocation LitEndLoc, 14863 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 14864 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(); 14865 14866 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc, 14867 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14868 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, 14869 TemplateArgs); 14870 14871 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14872 14873 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need 14874 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template. 14875 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14876 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) { 14877 case OR_Success: 14878 case OR_Deleted: 14879 break; 14880 14881 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 14882 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14883 PartialDiagnosticAt(UDSuffixLoc, 14884 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 14885 << R.getLookupName()), 14886 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14887 return ExprError(); 14888 14889 case OR_Ambiguous: 14890 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14891 PartialDiagnosticAt(R.getNameLoc(), PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 14892 << R.getLookupName()), 14893 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14894 return ExprError(); 14895 } 14896 14897 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function; 14898 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl, 14899 nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates, 14900 SuffixInfo.getLoc(), 14901 SuffixInfo.getInfo()); 14902 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 14903 return true; 14904 14905 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except 14906 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals. 14907 Expr *ConvArgs[2]; 14908 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 14909 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization( 14910 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)), 14911 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]); 14912 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 14913 return true; 14914 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get(); 14915 } 14916 14917 QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType(); 14918 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14919 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14920 14921 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = UserDefinedLiteral::Create( 14922 Context, Fn.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), ResultTy, 14923 VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14924 14925 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD)) 14926 return ExprError(); 14927 14928 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr)) 14929 return ExprError(); 14930 14931 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL), FD); 14932 } 14933 14934 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the 14935 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which 14936 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument 14937 /// dependent lookup. 14938 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success, 14939 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value 14940 /// is returned. 14941 Sema::ForRangeStatus 14942 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc, 14943 SourceLocation RangeLoc, 14944 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 14945 LookupResult &MemberLookup, 14946 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 14947 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) { 14948 Scope *S = nullptr; 14949 14950 CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14951 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) { 14952 ExprResult MemberRef = 14953 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc, 14954 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(), 14955 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 14956 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, 14957 MemberLookup, 14958 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 14959 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) { 14960 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14961 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14962 } 14963 *CallExpr = BuildCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr); 14964 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) { 14965 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14966 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14967 } 14968 } else { 14969 ExprResult FnR = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(/*NamingClass=*/nullptr, 14970 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 14971 NameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>()); 14972 if (FnR.isInvalid()) 14973 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14974 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(FnR.get()); 14975 14976 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc, 14977 CandidateSet, CallExpr); 14978 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) { 14979 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14980 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 14981 } 14982 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14983 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 14984 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best); 14985 14986 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) { 14987 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14988 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 14989 } 14990 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range, 14991 Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best, 14992 OverloadResult, 14993 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false); 14994 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) { 14995 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14996 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14997 } 14998 } 14999 return FRS_Success; 15000 } 15001 15002 15003 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 15004 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 15005 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 15006 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 15007 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 15008 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 15009 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 15010 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 15011 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 15012 Found, Fn); 15013 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 15014 return PE; 15015 15016 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 15017 } 15018 15019 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 15020 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 15021 Found, Fn); 15022 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 15023 SubExpr->getType()) && 15024 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 15025 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 15026 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 15027 return ICE; 15028 15029 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(), 15030 SubExpr, nullptr, ICE->getValueKind(), 15031 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 15032 } 15033 15034 if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) { 15035 if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) { 15036 Expr *SubExpr = 15037 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn); 15038 if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr()) 15039 return GSE; 15040 15041 // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic 15042 // selection expression. 15043 ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs(); 15044 SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end()); 15045 unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex(); 15046 AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr; 15047 15048 return GenericSelectionExpr::Create( 15049 Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(), 15050 GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(), 15051 GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(), 15052 ResultIdx); 15053 } 15054 // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic 15055 // selection expression. 15056 return GSE; 15057 } 15058 15059 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 15060 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 15061 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 15062 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 15063 if (Method->isStatic()) { 15064 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 15065 // from non-member functions. 15066 } else { 15067 // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an 15068 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 15069 // or template. 15070 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 15071 Found, Fn); 15072 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 15073 return UnOp; 15074 15075 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 15076 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 15077 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 15078 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 15079 15080 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 15081 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 15082 // appropriate pointer to member type. 15083 QualType ClassType 15084 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 15085 QualType MemPtrType 15086 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 15087 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 15088 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 15089 (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType); 15090 15091 return UnaryOperator::Create( 15092 Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 15093 UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 15094 } 15095 } 15096 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 15097 Found, Fn); 15098 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 15099 return UnOp; 15100 15101 return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 15102 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 15103 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), 15104 false, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 15105 } 15106 15107 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 15108 // FIXME: avoid copy. 15109 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 15110 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 15111 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 15112 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 15113 } 15114 15115 DeclRefExpr *DRE = 15116 BuildDeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, ULE->getNameInfo(), 15117 ULE->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(), 15118 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs); 15119 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1); 15120 return DRE; 15121 } 15122 15123 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 15124 // FIXME: avoid copy. 15125 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 15126 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 15127 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 15128 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 15129 } 15130 15131 Expr *Base; 15132 15133 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 15134 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 15135 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 15136 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 15137 DeclRefExpr *DRE = BuildDeclRefExpr( 15138 Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, MemExpr->getNameInfo(), 15139 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(), 15140 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs); 15141 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); 15142 return DRE; 15143 } else { 15144 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 15145 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 15146 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc(); 15147 Base = 15148 BuildCXXThisExpr(Loc, MemExpr->getBaseType(), /*IsImplicit=*/true); 15149 } 15150 } else 15151 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 15152 15153 ExprValueKind valueKind; 15154 QualType type; 15155 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 15156 valueKind = VK_LValue; 15157 type = Fn->getType(); 15158 } else { 15159 valueKind = VK_RValue; 15160 type = Context.BoundMemberTy; 15161 } 15162 15163 return BuildMemberExpr( 15164 Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(), 15165 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found, 15166 /*HadMultipleCandidates=*/true, MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), 15167 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary, TemplateArgs); 15168 } 15169 15170 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 15171 } 15172 15173 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 15174 DeclAccessPair Found, 15175 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 15176 return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn); 15177 } 15178